diff options
29 files changed, 1364 insertions, 1330 deletions
| diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/findsmb.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/findsmb.1.sgml index 0b3bbca017..090b1c8388 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/findsmb.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/findsmb.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="findsmb"> +<refentry id="findsmb.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>findsmb</refentrytitle> @@ -23,15 +23,16 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This perl script is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This perl script is part of the <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle><manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> +	suite.</para>  	<para><command>findsmb</command> is a perl script that  	prints out several pieces of information about machines   	on a subnet that respond to SMB  name query requests. -	It uses <ulink url="nmblookup.1.html"><command> -	nmblookup(1)</command></ulink> and <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"> -	<command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink> to obtain this information. +	It uses <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> +	and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> +	to obtain this information.  	</para>  </refsect1>		 @@ -45,16 +46,17 @@  		bugs in Windows95 into account when trying to find a Netbios name  		registered of the remote machine. This option is disabled by default  		because it is specific to Windows 95 and Windows 95 machines only.  -		If set, <ulink url="nmblookup.1.html"><command>nmblookup</command></ulink> +		If set, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>  		will be called with <constant>-B</constant> option.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>subnet broadcast address</term>  		<listitem><para>Without this option, <command>findsmb  		</command> will probe the subnet of the machine where  -		<command>findsmb</command> is run. This value is passed  -		to <command>nmblookup</command> as part of the  -		<constant>-B</constant> option.</para></listitem> +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>findsmb</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> +		is run. This value is passed to  +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> +		as part of the <constant>-B</constant> option.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist>  </refsect1> @@ -76,19 +78,21 @@  	version.</para>  	<para>The command with <constant>-r</constant> option -	must be run on a system without <ulink -	url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd</command></ulink> running.  +	must be run on a system without <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>	running.  +  	If <command>nmbd</command> is running on the system, you will   	only  get the IP address and the DNS name of the machine. To   	get proper responses  from Windows 95 and Windows 98 machines,   	the command must be run as root and with <constant>-r</constant>  	option on a machine without <command>nmbd</command> running.</para> -	<para>For example, running <command>findsmb</command> without  -	<constant>-r</constant> option set would yield output similar +	<para>For example, running <command>findsmb</command>  +	without <constant>-r</constant> option set would yield output similar  	to the following</para> -	<screen><computeroutput> +<screen>  IP ADDR         NETBIOS NAME   WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION   ---------------------------------------------------------------------   192.168.35.10   MINESET-TEST1  [DMVENGR] @@ -101,7 +105,7 @@ IP ADDR         NETBIOS NAME   WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION  192.168.35.88   SCNT2         +[MVENGR] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]  192.168.35.93   FROGSTAR-PC    [MVENGR] [Windows 5.0] [Windows 2000 LAN Manager]  192.168.35.97   HERBNT1       *[HERB-NT] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0] -	</computeroutput></screen> +</screen>  </refsect1> @@ -115,10 +119,12 @@ IP ADDR         NETBIOS NAME   WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1) -	</command></ulink>, and	<ulink url="nmblookup.1.html"> -	<command>nmblookup(1)</command></ulink> +	<para><citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, +	<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>  	</para>  </refsect1> @@ -132,11 +138,11 @@ IP ADDR         NETBIOS NAME   WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> -	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0  -	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink  +	url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>)  +	and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook +	XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/lmhosts.5.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/lmhosts.5.sgml index 7934c18e8e..a8a5f2c072 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/lmhosts.5.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/lmhosts.5.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="lmhosts"> +<refentry id="lmhosts.5">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle> @@ -13,15 +13,15 @@  </refnamediv>  <refsynopsisdiv> -	<para><filename>lmhosts</filename> is the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</para>  +	<para><filename>lmhosts</filename> is the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</para>   </refsynopsisdiv>  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This file is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This file is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><filename>lmhosts</filename> is the <emphasis>Samba  	</emphasis> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.  It  @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@  	<para>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.   	The two fields on each line are separated from each other by   	white space. Any entry beginning with '#' is ignored. Each line  -	in the lmhosts file contains the following information :</para> +	in the lmhosts file contains the following information:</para>  	<itemizedlist>  		<listitem><para>IP Address - in dotted decimal format.</para> @@ -52,16 +52,16 @@  		</listitem>  	</itemizedlist> -	<para>An example follows :</para> +	<para>An example follows:</para> -	<para><programlisting> +	<programlisting>  #  # Sample Samba lmhosts file.  #  192.9.200.1	TESTPC  192.9.200.20	NTSERVER#20  192.9.200.21	SAMBASERVER -	</programlisting></para> +	</programlisting>  	<para>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first   	and third will be returned for any queries for the names "TESTPC"  @@ -73,24 +73,24 @@  	be resolved.</para>  	<para>The default location of the <filename>lmhosts</filename> file  -	is in the same directory as the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"> 		 -	smb.conf(5)></ulink> file.</para> +	is in the same directory as the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1) -	</command></ulink>, <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER"> -	smb.conf(5)</ulink>, and <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command> -	smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> +	<para><citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>  	</para>  </refsect1> @@ -108,7 +108,8 @@  	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook +	XML 4.2 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/net.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/net.8.sgml index aab9032f14..62cee8c1d7 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/net.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/net.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="net"> +<refentry id="net.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>net</refentrytitle> @@ -42,8 +42,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>The samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility   	available for windows and DOS.</para> @@ -65,7 +65,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-w target-workgroup</term>  		<listitem><para> -		Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify either this option or the IP address or the name of a server. +		Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify  +		either this option or the IP address or the name of a server.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -86,7 +87,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-I ip-address</term>  		<listitem><para> -		IP address of target server to use. You have to specify either this option or a target workgroup or a target server. +		IP address of target server to use. You have to +		specify either this option or a target workgroup or a target server.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -114,7 +116,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-S server</term>  		<listitem><para> -		Name of target server. You should specify either this option or a target workgroup or a target IP address. +		Name of target server. You should specify either  +		this option or a target workgroup or a target IP address.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -211,7 +214,7 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>SYSTEM</term>  		<listitem><para> -		Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for /bin/date +		Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <command>/bin/date</command>  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -219,7 +222,7 @@  		<term>SET</term>  		<listitem><para>  		Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on  -		the remote server using /bin/date. +		the remote server using <command>/bin/date</command>.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -276,7 +279,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term>USER ADD <name> [password] [-F user flags] [misc. options</term> +		<term>USER ADD <name> [password] [-F user flags] [misc. options]</term>  		<listitem><para>  		Add specified user  		</para></listitem> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/nmbd.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/nmbd.8.sgml index db920c79a1..6c7ecce4e9 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/nmbd.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/nmbd.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="nmbd"> +<refentry id="nmbd.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> @@ -35,7 +35,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This program is part of the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>nmbd</command> is a server that understands   	and can reply to NetBIOS over IP name service requests, like  @@ -57,8 +58,8 @@  	option (see OPTIONS below). Thus <command>nmbd</command> will   	reply to broadcast queries for its own name(s). Additional  	names for <command>nmbd</command> to respond on can be set  -	via parameters in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename> -	smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> configuration file.</para> +	via parameters in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file.</para>  	<para><command>nmbd</command> can also be used as a WINS   	(Windows Internet Name Server) server. What this basically means  @@ -124,7 +125,7 @@  		server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this  		parameter negates the implicit daemon mode when run from the  		command line. <command>nmbd</command> also logs to standard -		output, as if the <command>-S</command> parameter had been +		output, as if the <constant>-S</constant> parameter had been  		given. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -147,10 +148,10 @@  		<listitem><para>NetBIOS lmhosts file.  The lmhosts   		file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that   		is loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name  -		resolution mechanism <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"> -		name resolve order</ulink> described in <ulink  -		url="smb.conf.5.html"> <filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> -		to resolve any NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note  +		resolution mechanism <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><parameter>name resolve +		order</parameter></ulink> described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> to resolve any  +		NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note   		that the contents of this file are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis>   		used by <command>nmbd</command> to answer any name queries.   		Adding a line to this file affects name NetBIOS resolution  @@ -160,9 +161,8 @@  		Samba as part of the build process. Common defaults   		are <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</filename>,  		<filename>/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</filename> or -		<filename>/etc/lmhosts</filename>. See the -		<ulink url="lmhosts.5.html"><filename>lmhosts(5)</filename></ulink> -		man page for details on the contents of this file.</para></listitem> +		<filename>/etc/samba/lmhosts</filename>. See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page for details on the contents of this file.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> @@ -191,9 +191,9 @@  		cryptic.</para>  		<para>Note that specifying this parameter here will override  -		the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel">log level</ulink>  -		parameter in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename> -		smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> file.</para></listitem> +		the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><parameter>log level</parameter></ulink>  +		parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> @@ -216,11 +216,12 @@  		<term>-n <primary NetBIOS name></term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to override  		the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical  -		to setting the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"> -		NetBIOS name</ulink> parameter in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">	 -		<filename>smb.conf</filename></ulink> file.  However, a command +		to setting the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><parameter>NetBIOS +		name</parameter></ulink> parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.  However, a command  		line setting will take precedence over settings in  -		<filename>smb.conf</filename>.</para></listitem> +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -241,8 +242,8 @@  		this may be changed when Samba is autoconfigured.</para>  		<para>The file specified contains the configuration details -		required by the server. See <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"> -		<filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> for more information. +		required by the server. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist> @@ -258,7 +259,7 @@  		<command>inetd</command> meta-daemon, this file  		must contain suitable startup information for the  		meta-daemon. See the <ulink -		url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> document +		url="install.html">install</ulink> document  		for details.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -271,7 +272,7 @@  		<para>If running the server as a daemon at startup,  		this file will need to contain an appropriate startup  		sequence for the server. See the <ulink -		url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> document +		url="install.html">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</ulink> document  		for details.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -281,21 +282,23 @@  		meta-daemon <command>inetd</command>, this file  		must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)  		to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp). -		See the <ulink url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> +		See the <ulink url="install.html">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</ulink>  		document for details.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term> -		<listitem><para>This is the default location of the -		<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf</filename></ulink> -		server configuration file. Other common places that systems +		<listitem><para>This is the default location of  +		the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> server +		configuration file. Other common places that systems  		install this file are <filename>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename> -		and <filename>/etc/smb.conf</filename>.</para> +		and <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename>.</para>  		<para>When run as a WINS server (see the -		<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT">wins support</ulink> -		parameter in the <filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> man page), +		<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT"><constant>wins support</constant></ulink> +		parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page),  		<command>nmbd</command>  		will store the WINS database in the file <filename>wins.dat</filename>  		in the <filename>var/locks</filename> directory configured under @@ -303,9 +306,9 @@  		<para>If <command>nmbd</command> is acting as a <emphasis>  		browse master</emphasis> (see the <ulink -		url="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER">local master</ulink> -		parameter in the <filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> man page, -		<command>nmbd</command> +		url="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER"><constant>local master</constant></ulink> +		parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page, <command>nmbd</command>  		will store the browsing database in the file <filename>browse.dat  		</filename> in the <filename>var/locks</filename> directory  		configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself. @@ -331,10 +334,11 @@  	cause <command>nmbd</command> to dump out its server database in  	the <filename>log.nmb</filename> file.</para> -	<para>The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered using -	<ulink url="smbcontrol.1.html"><command>smbcontrol(1)</command> -	</ulink> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer used in Samba 2.2). This is -	to allow transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running +	<para>The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered +	using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals +	are no longer used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow +	transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running   	at a normally low log level.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -348,14 +352,15 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><command>inetd(8)</command>, <ulink -	url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> -	</ulink>, <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1) -	</command></ulink>, <ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command> -	testparm(1)</command></ulink>, <ulink url="testprns.1.html"> -	<command>testprns(1)</command></ulink>, and the Internet RFC's -	<filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.  +	<para> +	<citerefentry><refentrytitle>inetd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and the Internet  +	RFC's <filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.   	In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available   	as a link from the Web page <ulink url="http://samba.org/cifs/">   	http://samba.org/cifs/</ulink>.</para> @@ -371,11 +376,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook +	XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/nmblookup.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/nmblookup.1.sgml index 33ae631ed9..7dd7f105d7 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/nmblookup.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/nmblookup.1.sgml @@ -36,8 +36,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>nmblookup</command> is used to query NetBIOS names   	and map them to IP addresses in a network using NetBIOS over TCP/IP  @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@  		query to a machine running a WINS server and the user wishes   		to query the names in the WINS server.  If this bit is unset   		the normal (broadcast responding) NetBIOS processing code  -		on a machine is used instead. See rfc1001, rfc1002 for details. +		on a machine is used instead. See RFC1001, RFC1002 for details.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -86,8 +86,8 @@  		where it ignores the source port of the requesting packet   	 	and only replies to UDP port 137. Unfortunately, on most UNIX   		systems root privilege is needed to bind to this port, and  -		in addition, if the <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>  -		daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port. +		in addition, if the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -115,7 +115,8 @@  		query to the broadcast address of the network interfaces as   		either auto-detected or defined in the <ulink   		url="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES"><parameter>interfaces</parameter> -		</ulink> parameter of the  <filename>smb.conf (5)</filename> file. +		</ulink> parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -198,7 +199,7 @@  		<listitem><para>This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending   		upon the previous options this may be a NetBIOS name or IP address.   		If a NetBIOS name then the different name types may be specified  -		by appending '#<type>' to the name. This name may also be +		by appending '#<type>' to the name. This name may also be  		'*', which will return all registered names within a broadcast   		area.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -211,8 +212,8 @@  		<para><command>nmblookup</command> can be used to query   		a WINS server (in the same way <command>nslookup</command> is  -		used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server,  -		<command>nmblookup</command> must be called like this:</para> +		used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server, <command>nmblookup</command>  +		must be called like this:</para>  		<para><command>nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</command></para> @@ -233,10 +234,10 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>, and	<ulink  -	url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -249,11 +250,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook +	XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/pdbedit.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/pdbedit.8.sgml index 1484bfec9a..e6231bfa8c 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/pdbedit.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/pdbedit.8.sgml @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN" [  <!ENTITY % globalentities SYSTEM '../global.ent'> %globalentities;  ]> -<refentry id="pdbedit"> +<refentry id="pdbedit.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>pdbedit</refentrytitle> @@ -42,8 +42,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts  	stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</para> @@ -67,12 +67,11 @@  		present in the users database.  		This option prints a list of user/uid pairs separated by  		the ':' character.</para> -  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -l</command></para> -		<para><programlisting> -		sorce:500:Simo Sorce -		samba:45:Test User -		</programlisting></para> +		<para><screen> +sorce:500:Simo Sorce +samba:45:Test User +</screen></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -85,26 +84,26 @@  		out the account fields in a descriptive format.</para>  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -l -v</command></para> -		<para><programlisting> -		--------------- -		username:       sorce -		user ID/Group:  500/500 -		user RID/GRID:  2000/2001 -		Full Name:      Simo Sorce -		Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\sorce -		HomeDir Drive:  H: -		Logon Script:   \\BERSERKER\netlogon\sorce.bat -		Profile Path:   \\BERSERKER\profile -		--------------- -		username:       samba -		user ID/Group:  45/45 -		user RID/GRID:  1090/1091 -		Full Name:      Test User -		Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba -		HomeDir Drive:   -		Logon Script:    -		Profile Path:   \\BERSERKER\profile -		</programlisting></para> +		<para><screen> +--------------- +username:       sorce +user ID/Group:  500/500 +user RID/GRID:  2000/2001 +Full Name:      Simo Sorce +Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\sorce +HomeDir Drive:  H: +Logon Script:   \\BERSERKER\netlogon\sorce.bat +Profile Path:   \\BERSERKER\profile +--------------- +username:       samba +user ID/Group:  45/45 +user RID/GRID:  1090/1091 +Full Name:      Test User +Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba +HomeDir Drive:   +Logon Script:    +Profile Path:   \\BERSERKER\profile +</screen></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -115,14 +114,15 @@  		<listitem><para>This option sets the "smbpasswd" listing format.  		It will make pdbedit list the users in the database, printing  		out the account fields in a format compatible with the -		<filename>smbpasswd</filename> file format. (see the <ulink -		url="smbpasswd.5.html"><filename>smbpasswd(5)</filename></ulink> for details)</para> +		<filename>smbpasswd</filename> file format. (see the +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details)</para>  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -l -w</command></para> -		<para><programlisting> -		sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:[UX         ]:LCT-00000000: -		samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX         ]:LCT-3BFA1E8D: -		</programlisting></para> +		<screen> +sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:[UX         ]:LCT-00000000: +samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX         ]:LCT-3BFA1E8D: +</screen>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -136,8 +136,6 @@  		operations.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		 -  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-f fullname</term> @@ -162,7 +160,6 @@  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-D drive</term>  		<listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or @@ -207,9 +204,10 @@  		ask for the password to be used.</para>  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -a -u sorce</command> -		<programlisting>new password: -		retype new password</programlisting> -                </para> +<programlisting>new password: +retype new password +</programlisting> +</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -281,9 +279,9 @@  		maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</para>  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt"</command></para> -		<para><programlisting> -		account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0 -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0 +</programlisting></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -296,10 +294,10 @@  		</para>  		<para>Example: <command>pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt" -V 3</command></para> -		<para><programlisting> -		account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0 -		account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3 -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0 +account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3 +</programlisting></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -327,9 +325,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html">smbpasswd(8)</ulink>,  -	<ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink> -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -342,11 +340,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook +	XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/rpcclient.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/rpcclient.1.sgml index 10e0ff438d..933938d438 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/rpcclient.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/rpcclient.1.sgml @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN" [  <!ENTITY % globalentities SYSTEM '../global.ent'> %globalentities;  ]> -<refentry id="rpcclient"> +<refentry id="rpcclient.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>rpcclient</refentrytitle> @@ -36,8 +36,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>rpcclient</command> is a utility initially developed  	to test MS-RPC functionality in Samba itself.  It has undergone  @@ -56,8 +56,8 @@  		<listitem><para>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.   		The server can be  any SMB/CIFS server.  The name is   		resolved using the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER"> -		<parameter>name resolve order</parameter></ulink> line from  -		<filename>smb.conf(5)</filename>.</para></listitem> +		<parameter>name resolve order</parameter></ulink> line from <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -68,11 +68,11 @@  		password used in the connection.  The format of the file is   		</para> -		<para><programlisting> -		username = <value>  -		password = <value> -		domain   = <value> -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +username = <value>  +password = <value> +domain   = <value> +</programlisting></para>  		<para>Make certain that the permissions on the file restrict   		access from unwanted users. </para></listitem> @@ -85,13 +85,10 @@  		<listitem><para>execute semicolon separated commands (listed   		below)) </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		 -				 -		 -		&stdarg.debuglevel;  		&stdarg.help; - +		&stdarg.debuglevel; +		  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-I IP-address</term>  		<listitem><para><replaceable>IP address</replaceable> is the address of the server to connect to.  @@ -163,9 +160,6 @@  		it in directly. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		 -		 -		  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-W|--workgroup=domain</term>  		<listitem><para>Set the SMB domain of the username.   This  @@ -175,7 +169,6 @@  		opposed to the Domain SAM). </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> -						  	</variablelist>  </refsect1> @@ -214,12 +207,10 @@  	</itemizedlist>  	<para> </para> - -  	<para><emphasis>SPOOLSS</emphasis></para>  	<itemizedlist> -		<listitem><para><command>adddriver <arch> <config></command>  +		<listitem><para><command>adddriver <arch> <config></command>   		- Execute an AddPrinterDriver() RPC to install the printer driver   		information on the server.  Note that the driver files should   		already exist in the directory returned by   @@ -229,16 +220,16 @@  		The <parameter>config</parameter> parameter is defined as   		follows: </para> -		<para><programlisting> -		Long Printer Name:\ -		Driver File Name:\ -		Data File Name:\ -		Config File Name:\ -		Help File Name:\ -		Language Monitor Name:\ -		Default Data Type:\ -		Comma Separated list of Files -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +Long Printer Name:\ +Driver File Name:\ +Data File Name:\ +Config File Name:\ +Help File Name:\ +Language Monitor Name:\ +Default Data Type:\ +Comma Separated list of Files +</programlisting></para>  		<para>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </para> @@ -248,10 +239,7 @@  		be "NULL".   On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a   		driver must already be installed prior to adding the driver or   		else the RPC will fail. </para></listitem> - - -		 -		 +	  		<listitem><para><command>addprinter <printername>   		<sharename> <drivername> <port></command>   		- Add a printer on the remote server.  This printer  @@ -387,7 +375,7 @@  	<para>From Luke Leighton's original rpcclient man page:</para> -	<para><emphasis>"WARNING!</emphasis> The MSRPC over SMB code has  +	<para><emphasis>WARNING!</emphasis> The MSRPC over SMB code has   	been developed from examining  Network traces. No documentation is   	available from the original creators  (Microsoft) on how MSRPC over   	SMB works, or how the individual MSRPC services  work. Microsoft's  @@ -395,12 +383,13 @@  	to be... a bit flaky in places. </para>  	<para>The development of Samba's implementation is also a bit rough,  -	and as more  of the services are understood, it can even result in  -	versions of  <command>smbd(8)</command> and <command>rpcclient(1)</command>  -	that are incompatible for some commands or  services. Additionally,  +	and as more of the services are understood, it can even result in  +	versions of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>rpcclient</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> that are incompatible for some commands or  services. Additionally,   	the developers are sending reports to Microsoft,  and problems found   	or reported to Microsoft are fixed in Service Packs,  which may  -	result in incompatibilities." </para> +	result in incompatibilities.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -422,7 +411,8 @@  	<para>The original rpcclient man page was written by Matthew   	Geddes, Luke Kenneth Casson Leighton, and rewritten by Gerald Carter.    	The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald  -	Carter.</para> +	Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was +	done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/samba.7.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/samba.7.sgml index 17865edd81..a352a6a7c6 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/samba.7.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/samba.7.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="samba"> +<refentry id="samba.7">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle> @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@  <refnamediv> -	<refname>SAMBA</refname> +	<refname>Samba</refname>  	<refpurpose>A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</refpurpose>  </refnamediv> @@ -29,26 +29,30 @@  	<variablelist>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>smbd</command></term> -		<listitem><para>The <command>smbd </command> -		daemon provides the file and print services to  +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term> +		<listitem><para>The <command>smbd</command> daemon provides the file and print services to   		SMB clients, such as Windows 95/98, Windows NT, Windows   		for Workgroups or LanManager. The configuration file  -		for this daemon is described in <filename>smb.conf</filename> +		for this daemon is described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>nmbd</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>nmbd</command>  		daemon provides NetBIOS nameservice and browsing  		support. The configuration file for this daemon  -		is described in <filename>smb.conf</filename></para> +		is described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>smbclient</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>smbclient</command>  		program implements a simple ftp-like client. This   		is useful for accessing SMB shares on other compatible @@ -59,15 +63,17 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>testparm</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>testparm</command> -		utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's -		<filename>smb.conf</filename>configuration file.</para> +		utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>testprns</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>testprns</command>  		utility supports testing printer names defined   		in your <filename>printcap</filename> file used  @@ -76,7 +82,8 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>smbstatus</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbstatus</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>smbstatus</command>  		tool provides access to information about the   		current connections to <command>smbd</command>.</para> @@ -84,7 +91,8 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>nmblookup</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>nmblookup</command>  		tools allows NetBIOS name queries to be made   		from a UNIX host.</para> @@ -92,15 +100,18 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>make_smbcodepage</command></term> -		<listitem><para>The <command>make_smbcodepage</command> -		utility provides a means of creating SMB code page  -		definition files for your <command>smbd</command> server.</para> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbgroupedit</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term> +		<listitem><para>The <command>smbgroupedit</command> +		tool allows for mapping unix groups to NT Builtin, +		Domain, or Local groups. Also it allows setting +		priviledges for that group, such as saAddUser, etc.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><command>smbpasswd</command></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>The <command>smbpasswd</command>  		command is a tool for changing LanMan and Windows NT   		password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</para> @@ -147,8 +158,8 @@  	list. Details on how to join the mailing list are given in   	the README file that comes with Samba.</para> -	<para>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Netscape  -	or Mosaic) then you will also find lots of useful information,  +	<para>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Mozilla +	or Konqueror) then you will also find lots of useful information,   	including back issues of the Samba mailing list, at  	<ulink url="http://lists.samba.org/">http://lists.samba.org</ulink>.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -156,7 +167,7 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the  +	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the   	Samba suite. </para>  </refsect1> @@ -170,8 +181,8 @@  	<para>If you have patches to submit, visit  	<ulink url="http://devel.samba.org/">http://devel.samba.org/</ulink> -	for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches in -	<command>diff -u</command> format.</para> +	for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches  +	in <command>diff -u</command> format.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -206,11 +217,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML +	4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smb.conf.5.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smb.conf.5.sgml index 01f767d256..9a2ea4fbde 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smb.conf.5.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smb.conf.5.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smb.conf"> +<refentry id="smb.conf.5">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> @@ -15,14 +15,13 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SYNOPSIS</title> -	<para>The <filename>smb.conf</filename> file is a configuration  -	file for the Samba suite. <filename>smb.conf</filename> contains  -	runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The -	<filename>smb.conf</filename> file is designed to be configured and  -	administered by the <ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command> -	</ulink> program. The complete description of the file format and  -	possible parameters held within are here for reference purposes.</para> -</refsect1> +	<para>The <filename>smb.conf</filename> file is a configuration   +	file for the Samba suite. <filename>smb.conf</filename> contains   +	runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The <filename>smb.conf</filename> file  +	is designed to be configured and  administered by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle>  +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> program. The complete +	description of the file format and possible parameters held within +	are here for reference purposes.</para> </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title id="FILEFORMATSECT">FILE FORMAT</title> @@ -105,13 +104,13 @@  	The user has write access to the path <filename>/home/bar</filename>.   	The share is accessed via the share name "foo":</para> -	<screen> -	<computeroutput> - 	[foo] - 		path = /home/bar - 		read only = no -	</computeroutput> -	</screen> +<screen> +<computeroutput> +[foo] +	path = /home/bar +	read only = no +</computeroutput> +</screen>  	<para>The following sample section defines a printable share.   	The share is readonly, but printable. That is, the only write  @@ -120,15 +119,15 @@  	access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified   	elsewhere):</para> -	<screen> -	<computeroutput> - 	[aprinter] - 		path = /usr/spool/public - 		read only = yes - 		printable = yes - 		guest ok = yes -	</computeroutput> -	</screen> +<screen> +<computeroutput> +[aprinter] +	path = /usr/spool/public +	read only = yes +	printable = yes +	guest ok = yes +</computeroutput> +</screen>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -192,12 +191,12 @@  		than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes]  		section:</para> -		<screen> -		<computeroutput> -	 	[homes] - 			read only = no -		</computeroutput> -		</screen> +<screen> +<computeroutput> +[homes] +	read only = no +</computeroutput> +</screen>  		<para>An important point is that if guest access is specified   		in the [homes] section, all home directories will be  @@ -257,12 +256,12 @@  		it. A typical [printers] entry would look like   		this:</para> -		<screen><computeroutput> -	 	[printers] - 			path = /usr/spool/public - 			guest ok = yes - 			printable = yes  -		</computeroutput></screen> +<screen><computeroutput> +[printers] +	path = /usr/spool/public +	guest ok = yes +	printable = yes  +</computeroutput></screen>  		<para>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file   		are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned.  @@ -270,11 +269,11 @@  		to set up a pseudo-printcap. This is a file consisting of one or   		more lines like this:</para> -		<screen> -		<computeroutput> -	        alias|alias|alias|alias...     -		</computeroutput> -		</screen> +<screen> +<computeroutput> +alias|alias|alias|alias...     +</computeroutput> +</screen>  		<para>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for   		your printing subsystem. In the [global] section, specify  @@ -472,7 +471,7 @@  	</variablelist>  	<para>There are some quite creative things that can be done  -	with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</para +	with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -552,7 +551,7 @@  	then steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</para> -	<orderedlist numeration="Arabic"> +	<orderedlist numeration="arabic">  		<listitem><para>If the client has passed a username/password   		pair and that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX   		system's password programs then the connection is made as that  @@ -805,7 +804,7 @@  		<listitem><para><link linkend="ALLOWHOSTS"><parameter>allow hosts</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para><link linkend="AVAILABLE"><parameter>available</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para><link linkend="BLOCKINGLOCKS"><parameter>blocking locks</parameter></link></para></listitem> -<listitem><para><link linkend="BLOCKSIZE"><parameter>block size</parameter></link></para></listitem> +		<listitem><para><link linkend="BLOCKSIZE"><parameter>block size</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para><link linkend="BROWSABLE"><parameter>browsable</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para><link linkend="BROWSEABLE"><parameter>browseable</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para><link linkend="CASESENSITIVE"><parameter>case sensitive</parameter></link></para></listitem> @@ -937,10 +936,10 @@  	<variablelist>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT">abort shutdown script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"/>abort shutdown script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para><emphasis>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</emphasis> -		This a full path name to a script called by -		<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>  that +		This a full path name to a script called by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> that  		should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <link   		linkend="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"><parameter>shutdown script</parameter></link>.</para> @@ -952,7 +951,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND">addprinter command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"/>addprinter command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing  		support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add  		Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the  @@ -966,12 +965,12 @@  		will perform the necessary operations for adding the printer  		to the print system and to add the appropriate service definition   		to the  <filename>smb.conf</filename> file in order that it can be  -		shared by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command> -		</ulink>.</para> +		shared by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  		<para>The <parameter>addprinter command</parameter> is  		automatically invoked with the following parameter (in  -		order:</para> +		order):</para>  		<itemizedlist>  			<listitem><para><parameter>printer name</parameter></para></listitem> @@ -997,7 +996,7 @@  		<para>See also <link linkend="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>  		deleteprinter command</parameter></link>, <link  -		linkend="printing"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>, +		linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>,  		<link linkend="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show add  		printer wizard</parameter></link></para> @@ -1010,7 +1009,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADDSHARECOMMAND">add share command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADDSHARECOMMAND"/>add share command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically   		add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The   		<parameter>add share command</parameter> is used to define an  @@ -1064,9 +1063,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADDMACHINESCRIPT">add machine script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADDMACHINESCRIPT"/>add machine script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will  -		be run by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>  when a machine is added +		be run by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when a machine is added                  to it's domain using the administrator username and password method. </para>  		<para>This option is only required when using sam back-ends tied to the @@ -1082,7 +1082,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADSSERVER">ads server (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADSSERVER"/>ads server (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this option is specified, samba does   		not try to figure out what ads server to use itself, but   		uses the specified ads server. Either one DNS name or IP  @@ -1095,10 +1095,10 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADDUSERSCRIPT">add user script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADDUSERSCRIPT"/>add user script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will  -		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8) -		</ulink> under special circumstances described below.</para> +		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> under special circumstances described below.</para>  		<para>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are   		created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites  @@ -1108,16 +1108,16 @@  		url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> to create the required UNIX users   		<emphasis>ON DEMAND</emphasis> when a user accesses the Samba server.</para> -		<para>In order to use this option, <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink>  -		must <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be set to <parameter>security = share</parameter> +		<para>In order to use this option, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> must <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be set to <parameter>security = share</parameter>  		and <parameter>add user script</parameter>  		must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX   		user given one argument of <parameter>%u</parameter>, which expands into   		the UNIX user name to create.</para>  		<para>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server,  -		at login (session setup in the SMB protocol) time, <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		smbd</ulink> contacts the <parameter>password server</parameter> and  +		at login (session setup in the SMB protocol) time, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> contacts the <parameter>password server</parameter> and   		attempts to authenticate the given user with the given password. If the   		authentication succeeds then <command>smbd</command>   		attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX password database to map the  @@ -1145,10 +1145,10 @@  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		<varlistentry><term><anchor id="ADDGROUPSCRIPT">add group script (G)</term> +		<varlistentry><term><anchor id="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"/>add group script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will  -		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <ulink -                url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> when a new group is +		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when a new group is                  requested. It will expand any                  <parameter>%g</parameter> to the group name passed.                  This script is only useful for installations using the @@ -1161,7 +1161,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADMINUSERS">admin users (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADMINUSERS"/>admin users (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users who will be granted   		administrative privileges on the share. This means that they   		will do all file operations as the super-user (root).</para> @@ -1177,13 +1177,13 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT">add user to group script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"/>add user to group script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Full path to the script that will be called when   		a user is added to a group using the Windows NT domain administration  -		tools. It will be run by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>  -		<emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>. Any <parameter>%g</parameter> will be  -		replaced with the group name and any <parameter>%u</parameter> will  -		be replaced with the user name. +		tools. It will be run by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>	<emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>.  +		Any <parameter>%g</parameter> will be replaced with the group name and  +		any <parameter>%u</parameter> will be replaced with the user name.  		</para>  		<para>Default: <command>add user to group script = </command></para> @@ -1194,13 +1194,13 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ALLOWHOSTS">allow hosts (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ALLOWHOSTS"/>allow hosts (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="HOSTSALLOW">  		<parameter>hosts allow</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE">algorithmic rid base (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"/>algorithmic rid base (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This determines how Samba will use its                  algorithmic mapping from uids/gid to the RIDs needed to construct                  NT Security Identifiers.</para> @@ -1223,7 +1223,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS">allow trusted domains (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"/>allow trusted domains (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option only takes effect when the <link   		linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>security</parameter></link> option is set to   		<constant>server</constant> or <constant>domain</constant>.   @@ -1247,10 +1247,9 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEAS">announce as (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This specifies what type of server  -		<ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd</command></ulink>  -		will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse  +		<term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEAS"/>announce as (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This specifies what type of server <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse   		list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options   		are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"),   		"NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server,  @@ -1269,7 +1268,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEVERSION">announce version (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEVERSION"/>announce version (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This specifies the major and minor version numbers   		that nmbd will use when announcing itself as a server. The default   		is 4.9.  Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific  @@ -1284,7 +1283,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="AUTOSERVICES">auto services (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="AUTOSERVICES"/>auto services (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a synonym for the <link linkend="PRELOAD">  		<parameter>preload</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -1293,7 +1292,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="AUTHMETHODS">auth methods (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="AUTHMETHODS"/>auth methods (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows the administrator to chose what                  authentication methods <command>smbd</command> will use when authenticating                  a user.  This option defaults to sensible values based on <link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter> @@ -1311,7 +1310,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="AVAILABLE">available (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="AVAILABLE"/>available (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If   		<parameter>available = no</parameter>, then <emphasis>ALL</emphasis>   		attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are  @@ -1325,12 +1324,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BINDINTERFACESONLY">bind interfaces only (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="BINDINTERFACESONLY"/>bind interfaces only (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This global parameter allows the Samba admin   		to limit what interfaces on a machine will serve SMB requests. It  -		affects file service <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> and  -		name service <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> in slightly  -		different ways.</para> +		affects file service <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and name service <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> in a slightly different ways.</para>  		<para>For name service it causes <command>nmbd</command> to bind   		to ports 137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in the <link  @@ -1350,8 +1349,9 @@  		does defeat this simple check, however, so it must not be used  		seriously as a security feature for <command>nmbd</command>.</para> -		<para>For file service it causes <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> -		to bind only to the interface list given in the <link linkend="INTERFACES"> +		<para>For file service it causes <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to bind only to the interface list  +		given in the <link linkend="INTERFACES">  		interfaces</link> parameter. This restricts the networks that   		<command>smbd</command> will serve to packets coming in those   		interfaces.  Note that you should not use this parameter for machines  @@ -1360,10 +1360,9 @@  		<para>If <parameter>bind interfaces only</parameter> is set then   		unless the network address <emphasis>127.0.0.1</emphasis> is added  -		to the <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list <ulink -		url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink>  -		and <ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command></ulink> may  -		not work as expected due to the reasons covered below.</para> +		to the <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> may not work as expected due to the reasons covered below.</para>  		<para>To change a users SMB password, the <command>smbpasswd</command>  		by default connects to the <emphasis>localhost - 127.0.0.1</emphasis>  @@ -1373,9 +1372,9 @@  		<parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list then <command>  		smbpasswd</command> will fail to connect in it's default mode.   		<command>smbpasswd</command> can be forced to use the primary IP interface  -		of the local host by using its <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr"> -		<parameter>-r <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable></parameter> -		</ulink> parameter, with <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable> set  +		of the local host by using its <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>	<parameter>-r <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable></parameter> +		parameter, with <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable> set   		to the IP name of the primary interface of the local host.</para>  		<para>The <command>swat</command> status page tries to connect with @@ -1395,9 +1394,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BLOCKINGLOCKS">blocking locks (S)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the behavior of <ulink  -		url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> when given a request by a client  +		<term><anchor id="BLOCKINGLOCKS"/>blocking locks (S)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the behavior  +		of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when given a request by a client   		to obtain a byte range lock on a region of an open file, and the   		request has a time limit associated with it.</para> @@ -1417,9 +1417,9 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BLOCKSIZE">block size (S)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the behavior of  -		<ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> when reporting disk free  +		<term><anchor id="BLOCKSIZE"/>block size (S)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the behavior of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when reporting disk free   		sizes. By default, this reports a disk block size of 1024 bytes.  		</para>         @@ -1433,27 +1433,19 @@  		<para>Changing this option does not change the disk free reporting  		size, just the block size unit reported to the client.</para> - -																		        <para>Default: <command>block size = 1024</command></para> -																				        <para>Example: <command>block size = 65536</command></para> - -																						        </listitem> -																								        </varlistentry> -																										 - +		</listitem> +		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BROWSABLE">browsable (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="BROWSABLE"/>browsable (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>See the <link linkend="BROWSEABLE"><parameter>  		browseable</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> - -  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BROWSELIST">browse list (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This controls whether <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		<command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> will serve a browse list to  +		<term><anchor id="BROWSELIST"/>browse list (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This controls whether <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will serve a browse list to   		a client doing a <command>NetServerEnum</command> call. Normally   		set to <constant>yes</constant>. You should never need to change   		this.</para> @@ -1464,7 +1456,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="BROWSEABLE">browseable (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="BROWSEABLE"/>browseable (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether this share is seen in   		the list of available shares in a net view and in the browse list.</para> @@ -1475,7 +1467,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CASESENSITIVE"/>case sensitive (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>See the discussion in the section <link   		linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">NAME MANGLING</link>.</para> @@ -1486,7 +1478,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CASESIGNAMES">casesignames (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CASESIGNAMES"/>casesignames (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="CASESENSITIVE">case   		sensitive</link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -1494,12 +1486,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT">change notify timeout (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"/>change notify timeout (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This SMB allows a client to tell a server to   		"watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to  		the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of -		a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		<command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> daemon only performs such a scan  +		a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon only performs such a scan   		on each requested directory once every <parameter>change notify   		timeout</parameter> seconds.</para> @@ -1512,7 +1504,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CHANGESHARECOMMAND">change share command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"/>change share command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically   		add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The   		<parameter>change share command</parameter> is used to define an  @@ -1562,12 +1554,8 @@  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> - -		 - -		  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="COMMENT">comment (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="COMMENT"/>comment (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a text field that is seen next to a share   		when a client does a queries the server, either via the network   		neighborhood or via <command>net view</command> to list what shares  @@ -1584,7 +1572,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CONFIGFILE">config file (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CONFIGFILE"/>config file (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This allows you to override the config file   		to use, instead of the default (usually <filename>smb.conf</filename>).   		There is a chicken and egg problem here as this option is set  @@ -1608,7 +1596,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="COPY">copy (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="COPY"/>copy (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows you to "clone" service   		entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the   		current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current  @@ -1626,7 +1614,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CREATEMASK">create mask (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CREATEMASK"/>create mask (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>A synonym for this parameter is   		<link linkend="CREATEMODE"><parameter>create mode</parameter>  		</link>.</para> @@ -1670,14 +1658,14 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CREATEMODE">create mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CREATEMODE"/>create mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a synonym for <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>  		create mask</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="CSCPOLICY">csc policy (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="CSCPOLICY"/>csc policy (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This stands for <emphasis>client-side caching   		policy</emphasis>, and specifies how clients capable of offline  		caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values @@ -1696,7 +1684,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEADTIME">deadtime (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEADTIME"/>deadtime (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer)   		represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection   		is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes  @@ -1722,7 +1710,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP">debug hires timestamp (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"/>debug hires timestamp (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages   		are needed with a resolution of higher that seconds, this   		boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp  @@ -1739,7 +1727,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEBUGPID">debug pid (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEBUGPID"/>debug pid (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>When using only one log file for more then one   		forked <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink>-process there may be hard to follow which process   		outputs which message. This boolean parameter is adds the process-id  @@ -1754,7 +1742,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"/>debug timestamp (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Samba debug log messages are timestamped   		by default. If you are running at a high <link linkend="DEBUGLEVEL">  		<parameter>debug level</parameter></link> these timestamps @@ -1767,7 +1755,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEBUGUID">debug uid (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEBUGUID"/>debug uid (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime   		run as the connected user, this boolean parameter inserts the   		current euid, egid, uid and gid to the timestamp message headers  @@ -1783,7 +1771,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEBUGLEVEL">debuglevel (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEBUGLEVEL"/>debuglevel (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="LOGLEVEL"><parameter>  		log level</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -1792,7 +1780,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEFAULT">default (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEFAULT"/>default (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>A synonym for <link linkend="DEFAULTSERVICE"><parameter>  		default service</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -1800,7 +1788,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTCASE">default case (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTCASE"/>default case (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">  		NAME MANGLING</link>. Also note the <link linkend="SHORTPRESERVECASE">  		<parameter>short preserve case</parameter></link> parameter.</para> @@ -1812,7 +1800,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTDEVMODE">default devmode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTDEVMODE"/>default devmode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is only applicable to <link  		linkend="PRINTOK">printable</link> services.  When smbd is serving  		Printer Drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients, each printer on the Samba @@ -1850,7 +1838,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTSERVICE">default service (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DEFAULTSERVICE"/>default service (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a service  		which will be connected to if the service actually requested cannot  		be found. Note that the square brackets are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> @@ -1876,24 +1864,27 @@  		<para>Example:</para> -		<para><programlisting> +<para><programlisting>  [global]  	default service = pub  [pub]  	path = /%S -		</programlisting></para> +</programlisting></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> -		<varlistentry><term><anchor id="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT">delete group script (G)</term> +		<varlistentry><term><anchor id="DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"/>delete group script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will  -		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> when a group is requested to be deleted. It will expand any <parameter>%g</parameter> to the group name passed.  This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools. +		be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when a group is requested to be deleted.  +		It will expand any <parameter>%g</parameter> to the group name passed.   +		This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT domain administration tools.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">deleteprinter command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"/>deleteprinter command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer  		support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, it is now   		possible to delete printer at run time by issuing the  @@ -1919,7 +1910,7 @@  		<para>See also <link linkend="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>  		addprinter command</parameter></link>, <link  -		linkend="printing"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>, +		linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>,  		<link linkend="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show add  		printer wizard</parameter></link></para> @@ -1935,7 +1926,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETEREADONLY">delete readonly (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETEREADONLY"/>delete readonly (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.    		This is not normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.</para> @@ -1949,7 +1940,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETESHARECOMMAND">delete share command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETESHARECOMMAND"/>delete share command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically   		add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager.  The   		<parameter>delete share command</parameter> is used to define an  @@ -1997,10 +1988,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETEUSERSCRIPT">delete user script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"/>delete user script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will  -		be run by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> -                when managing user's with remote RPC (NT) tools. +		be run by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when managing users  +		with remote RPC (NT) tools.  		</para>                  <para>This script is called when a remote client removes a user @@ -2018,13 +2010,13 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT">delete user from group script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"/>delete user from group script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Full path to the script that will be called when   		a user is removed from a group using the Windows NT domain administration  -		tools. It will be run by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>  -		<emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>. Any <parameter>%g</parameter> will be  -		replaced with the group name and any <parameter>%u</parameter> will  -		be replaced with the user name. +		tools. It will be run by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>.  +		Any <parameter>%g</parameter> will be replaced with the group name and  +		any <parameter>%u</parameter> will be replaced with the user name.  		</para>  		<para>Default: <command>delete user from group script = </command></para> @@ -2035,7 +2027,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DELETEVETOFILES">delete veto files (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DELETEVETOFILES"/>delete veto files (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option is used when Samba is attempting to   		delete a directory that contains one or more vetoed directories   		(see the <link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>veto files</parameter></link> @@ -2064,7 +2056,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DENYHOSTS">deny hosts (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DENYHOSTS"/>deny hosts (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="HOSTSDENY"><parameter>hosts   		deny</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -2073,7 +2065,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DFREECOMMAND">dfree command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DFREECOMMAND"/>dfree command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The <parameter>dfree command</parameter> setting should   		only be used on systems where a problem occurs with the internal   		disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix,  @@ -2106,17 +2098,17 @@  		<para>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:</para> -		<para><programlisting>  -		#!/bin/sh -		df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting>  +#!/bin/sh +df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' +</programlisting></para>  		<para>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):</para> -		<para><programlisting>  -		#!/bin/sh -		/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}' -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting>  +#!/bin/sh +/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}' +</programlisting></para>  		<para>Note that you may have to replace the command names   		with full path names on some systems.</para> @@ -2127,7 +2119,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORY">directory (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORY"/>directory (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PATH"><parameter>path  		</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -2135,7 +2127,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMASK"/>directory mask (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is the octal modes which are   		used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX   		directories.</para> @@ -2183,7 +2175,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMODE">directory mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMODE"/>directory mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"><parameter>  		directory mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -2191,7 +2183,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK">directory security mask (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"/>directory security mask (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits   		can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX   		permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog  @@ -2226,7 +2218,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DISABLENETBIOS">disable netbios (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DISABLENETBIOS"/>disable netbios (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Enabling this parameter will disable netbios support  		in Samba. Netbios is the only available form of browsing in   		all windows versions except for 2000 and XP. </para> @@ -2241,7 +2233,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DISABLESPOOLSS">disable spoolss (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DISABLESPOOLSS"/>disable spoolss (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Enabling this parameter will disable Samba's support  		for the SPOOLSS set of MS-RPC's and will yield identical behavior  		as Samba 2.0.x.  Windows NT/2000 clients will downgrade to using @@ -2262,7 +2254,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DISPLAYCHARSET">display charset (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DISPLAYCHARSET"/>display charset (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies the charset that samba will use   		to print messages to stdout and stderr and SWAT will use.   		Should generally be the same as the <command>unix charset</command>. @@ -2277,12 +2269,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DNSPROXY">dns proxy (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>Specifies that <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>  -		when acting as a WINS server and finding that a NetBIOS name has not  -		been registered, should treat the NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS  -		name and do a lookup with the DNS server for that name on behalf of  -		the name-querying client.</para> +		<term><anchor id="DNSPROXY"/>dns proxy (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>Specifies that <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when acting as a WINS server and  +		finding that a NetBIOS name has not been registered, should treat the  +		NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS name and do a lookup with the DNS server  +		for that name on behalf of the name-querying client.</para>  		<para>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15   		characters, so the DNS name (or DNS alias) can likewise only be  @@ -2300,7 +2292,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DOMAINLOGONS"/>domain logons (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If set to <constant>yes</constant>, the Samba server will serve   		Windows 95/98 Domain logons for the <link linkend="WORKGROUP">  		<parameter>workgroup</parameter></link> it is in. Samba 2.2 @@ -2315,20 +2307,20 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOMAINMASTER">domain master (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>Tell <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command> -		nmbd(8)</command></ulink> to enable WAN-wide browse list +		<term><anchor id="DOMAINMASTER"/>domain master (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>Tell <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to enable WAN-wide browse list  		collation. Setting this option causes <command>nmbd</command> to  		claim a special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies   		it as a domain master browser for its given <link linkend="WORKGROUP">  		<parameter>workgroup</parameter></link>. Local master browsers   		in the same <parameter>workgroup</parameter> on broadcast-isolated   		subnets will give this <command>nmbd</command> their local browse lists,  -		and then ask <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>  -		for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area  -		network.  Browser clients will then contact their local master browser,  -		and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list  -		for their broadcast-isolated subnet.</para> +		and then ask <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> for a complete copy of the browse  +		list for the whole wide area network.  Browser clients will then contact  +		their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list,  +		instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet.</para>  		<para>Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be   		able to claim this <parameter>workgroup</parameter> specific special  @@ -2353,7 +2345,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DONTDESCEND">dont descend (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DONTDESCEND"/>dont descend (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>There are certain directories on some systems   		(e.g., the <filename>/proc</filename> tree under Linux) that are either not   		of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This  @@ -2372,7 +2364,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOSCHARSET">dos charset (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DOSCHARSET"/>dos charset (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>DOS SMB clients assume the server has   		the same charset as they do. This option specifies which   		charset Samba should talk to DOS clients. @@ -2380,14 +2372,14 @@  		<para>The default depends on which charsets you have instaled.   		Samba tries to use charset 850 but falls back to ASCII in  -		case it is not available. Run <ulink url="testparm.1.html">testparm(1) -		</ulink> to check the default on your system. +		case it is not available. Run <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> to check the default on your system.  		</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOSFILEMODE">dos filemode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DOSFILEMODE"/>dos filemode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para> The default behavior in Samba is to provide   		UNIX-like behavior where only the owner of a file/directory is   		able to change the permissions on it.  However, this behavior @@ -2406,13 +2398,13 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION">dos filetime resolution (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"/>dos filetime resolution (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest   		granularity on time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter   		for a share causes Samba to round the reported time down to the   		nearest two second boundary when a query call that requires one second  -		resolution is made to <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command> -		</ulink>.</para> +		resolution is made to <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  		<para>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual   		C++ when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a  @@ -2432,14 +2424,15 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMES">dos filetimes (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMES"/>dos filetimes (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a   		file they can change the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics,   		only the owner of the file or root may change the timestamp. By   		default, Samba runs with POSIX semantics and refuses to change the   		timestamp on a file if the user <command>smbd</command> is acting   		on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <constant> -		yes</constant> allows DOS semantics and <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will change the file  +		yes</constant> allows DOS semantics and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will change the file   		timestamp as DOS requires.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>dos filetimes = no</command></para></listitem> @@ -2448,7 +2441,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"/>encrypt passwords (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords   		will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and   		above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords  @@ -2457,10 +2450,11 @@  		directory <filename>docs/</filename> shipped with the source code.</para>  		<para>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly -		<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> must either  -		have access to a local <ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html"><filename>smbpasswd(5) -		</filename></ulink> file (see the <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command> -		smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> program for information on how to set up  +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> must either  +		have access to a local <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file (see the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> program for information on how to set up    		and maintain this file), or set the <link  		linkend="SECURITY">security = [server|domain|ads]</link> parameter which   		causes <command>smbd</command> to authenticate against another  @@ -2471,7 +2465,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ENHANCEDBROWSING">enhanced browsing (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ENHANCEDBROWSING"/>enhanced browsing (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option enables a couple of enhancements to   		cross-subnet browse propagation that have been added in Samba   		but which are not standard in Microsoft implementations.   @@ -2497,7 +2491,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND">enumports command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"/>enumports command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign  		to UNIX hosts.  Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port  		is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of @@ -2520,7 +2514,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="EXEC">exec (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="EXEC"/>exec (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a synonym for <link linkend="PREEXEC">  		<parameter>preexec</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -2528,7 +2522,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES">fake directory create times (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"/>fake directory create times (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create   		time for all files and directories. This is not the same as the   		ctime - status change time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default  @@ -2562,7 +2556,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FAKEOPLOCKS">fake oplocks (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FAKEOPLOCKS"/>fake oplocks (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission   		from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants   		an oplock (opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume  @@ -2594,10 +2588,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FOLLOWSYMLINKS">follow symlinks (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"/>follow symlinks (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows the Samba administrator  -		to stop <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>  -		from following symbolic links in a particular share. Setting this  +		to stop <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>	from following symbolic  +		links in a particular share. Setting this   		parameter to <constant>no</constant> prevents any file or directory   		that is a symbolic link from being followed (the user will get an   		error).  This option is very useful to stop users from adding a  @@ -2614,7 +2609,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCECREATEMODE">force create mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCECREATEMODE"/>force create mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit   		permissions that will <emphasis>always</emphasis> be set on a   		file created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto  @@ -2642,7 +2637,7 @@   		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE">force directory mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"/>force directory mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit   		permissions that will <emphasis>always</emphasis> be set on a directory   		created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the  @@ -2671,7 +2666,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE">force directory security mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"/>force directory security mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits   		can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX   		permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog box.</para> @@ -2707,7 +2702,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCEGROUP">force group (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCEGROUP"/>force group (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be   		assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting   		to this service. This is useful for sharing files by ensuring  @@ -2743,7 +2738,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCESECURITYMODE">force security mode (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCESECURITYMODE"/>force security mode (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission   		bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating   		the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog  @@ -2781,7 +2776,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FORCEUSER">force user (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FORCEUSER"/>force user (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be   		assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service.   		This is useful for sharing files. You should also use it carefully  @@ -2809,11 +2804,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="FSTYPE">fstype (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="FSTYPE"/>fstype (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows the administrator to   		configure the string that specifies the type of filesystem a share  -		is using that is reported by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8) -		</command></ulink> when a client queries the filesystem type +		is using that is reported by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when a client queries the filesystem type  		for a share. The default type is <constant>NTFS</constant> for   		compatibility with Windows NT but this can be changed to other   		strings such as <constant>Samba</constant> or <constant>FAT @@ -2826,7 +2821,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="GETWDCACHE">getwd cache (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="GETWDCACHE"/>getwd cache (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a   		caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd()   		calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially  @@ -2840,7 +2835,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="GROUP">group (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="GROUP"/>group (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="FORCEGROUP"><parameter>force   		group</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -2848,7 +2843,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="GUESTACCOUNT">guest account (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="GUESTACCOUNT"/>guest account (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a username which will be used for access   		to services which are specified as <link linkend="GUESTOK"><parameter>  		guest ok</parameter></link> (see below). Whatever privileges this  @@ -2878,7 +2873,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="GUESTOK">guest ok (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="GUESTOK"/>guest ok (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant> for   		a service, then no password is required to connect to the service.   		Privileges will be those of the <link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter> @@ -2894,7 +2889,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="GUESTONLY">guest only (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="GUESTONLY"/>guest only (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant> for   		a service, then only guest connections to the service are permitted.   		This parameter will have no effect if <link linkend="GUESTOK"> @@ -2910,7 +2905,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDEDOTFILES">hide dot files (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDEDOTFILES"/>hide dot files (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether   		files starting with a dot appear as hidden files.</para> @@ -2920,7 +2915,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDEFILES">hide files(S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDEFILES"/>hide files(S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of files or directories that are not   		visible but are accessible.  The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied   		to any files or directories that match.</para> @@ -2958,7 +2953,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDELOCALUSERS">hide local users(G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDELOCALUSERS"/>hide local users(G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter toggles the hiding of local UNIX   		users (root, wheel, floppy, etc) from remote clients.</para> @@ -2968,7 +2963,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDEUNREADABLE">hide unreadable (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDEUNREADABLE"/>hide unreadable (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter prevents clients from seeing the  		existance of files that cannot be read. Defaults to off.</para> @@ -2977,7 +2972,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES">hide unwriteable files (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"/>hide unwriteable files (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter prevents clients from seeing  		the existance of files that cannot be written to. Defaults to off.  		Note that unwriteable directories are shown as usual. @@ -2988,7 +2983,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HIDESPECIALFILES">hide special files (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HIDESPECIALFILES"/>hide special files (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter prevents clients from seeing  		special files such as sockets, devices and fifo's in directory   		listings. @@ -2999,10 +2994,10 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOMEDIRMAP">homedir map (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOMEDIRMAP"/>homedir map (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If<link linkend="NISHOMEDIR"><parameter>nis homedir -		</parameter></link> is <constant>yes</constant>, and <ulink  -		url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> is also acting  +		</parameter></link> is <constant>yes</constant>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> is also acting   		as a Win95/98 <parameter>logon server</parameter> then this parameter   		specifies the NIS (or YP) map from which the server for the user's   		home directory should be extracted.  At present, only the Sun  @@ -3032,7 +3027,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOSTMSDFS">host msdfs (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOSTMSDFS"/>host msdfs (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available   		if Samba has been configured and compiled with the <command>  		--with-msdfs</command> option. If set to <constant>yes</constant>,  @@ -3050,7 +3045,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS">hostname lookups (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"/>hostname lookups (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies whether samba should use (expensive)  		hostname lookups or use the ip addresses instead. An example place  		where hostname lookups are currently used is when checking  @@ -3066,7 +3061,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOSTSALLOW">hosts allow (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOSTSALLOW"/>hosts allow (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>A synonym for this parameter is <parameter>allow   		hosts</parameter>.</para> @@ -3115,9 +3110,9 @@  		<para>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</para> -		<para>See <ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command>testparm(1)</command> -		</ulink> for a way of testing your host access to see if it does  -		what you expect.</para> +		<para>See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> for a way of testing your host access  +		to see if it does what you expect.</para>  		<para>Default: <emphasis>none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)  		</emphasis></para> @@ -3130,7 +3125,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOSTSDENY">hosts deny (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOSTSDENY"/>hosts deny (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>The opposite of <parameter>hosts allow</parameter>   		- hosts listed here are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> permitted access to   		services unless the specific services have their own lists to override  @@ -3147,7 +3142,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="HOSTSEQUIV">hosts equiv (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="HOSTSEQUIV"/>hosts equiv (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this global parameter is a non-null string,   		it specifies the name of a file to read for the names of hosts   		and users who will be allowed access without specifying a password. @@ -3176,7 +3171,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="INCLUDE">include (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="INCLUDE"/>include (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This allows you to include one config file   		inside another.  The file is included literally, as though typed   		in place.</para> @@ -3193,7 +3188,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="INHERITACLS">inherit acls (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="INHERITACLS"/>inherit acls (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter can be used to ensure  		that if default acls exist on parent directories,  		they are always honored when creating a subdirectory. @@ -3211,7 +3206,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="INHERITPERMISSIONS">inherit permissions (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="INHERITPERMISSIONS"/>inherit permissions (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>The permissions on new files and directories   		are normally governed by <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>  		create mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"> @@ -3252,7 +3247,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="INTERFACES">interfaces (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="INTERFACES"/>interfaces (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to override the default   		network interfaces list that Samba will use for browsing, name   		registration and other NBT traffic. By default Samba will query  @@ -3304,7 +3299,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="INVALIDUSERS">invalid users (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="INVALIDUSERS"/>invalid users (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users that should not be allowed   		to login to this service. This is really a <emphasis>paranoid</emphasis>   		check to absolutely ensure an improper setting does not breach  @@ -3316,12 +3311,12 @@  		<para>A name starting with '+' is interpreted only   		by looking in the UNIX group database. A name starting with  -		'&' is interpreted only by looking in the NIS netgroup database  +		'&' is interpreted only by looking in the NIS netgroup database   		(this requires NIS to be working on your system). The characters  -		'+' and '&' may be used at the start of the name in either order  +		'+' and '&' may be used at the start of the name in either order   		so the value <parameter>+&group</parameter> means check the   		UNIX group database, followed by the NIS netgroup database, and  -		the value <parameter>&+group</parameter> means check the NIS +		the value <parameter>&+group</parameter> means check the NIS  		netgroup database, followed by the UNIX group database (the   		same as the '@' prefix).</para> @@ -3340,7 +3335,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="KEEPALIVE">keepalive (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="KEEPALIVE"/>keepalive (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents   		the number of seconds between <parameter>keepalive</parameter>   		packets. If this parameter is zero, no keepalive packets will be  @@ -3360,7 +3355,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="KERNELOPLOCKS">kernel oplocks (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="KERNELOPLOCKS"/>kernel oplocks (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>For UNIXes that support kernel based <link  		linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link>  		(currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter  @@ -3368,10 +3363,10 @@  		<para>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <parameter>oplocks  		</parameter> to be broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation  -		accesses a file that <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command> -		</ulink> has oplocked. This allows complete data consistency between  -		SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is a <emphasis>very</emphasis>  -		cool feature :-).</para> +		accesses a file that <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> has oplocked. This allows complete  +		data consistency between SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is  +		a <emphasis>very</emphasis> cool feature :-).</para>  		<para>This parameter defaults to <constant>on</constant>, but is translated  		to a no-op on systems that no not have the necessary kernel support. @@ -3389,12 +3384,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LANMANAUTH">lanman auth (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will -		attempt to authenticate users using the LANMAN password hash. -		If disabled, only clients which support NT password hashes (e.g. Windows  -		NT/2000 clients, smbclient, etc... but not Windows 95/98 or the MS DOS  -		network client) will be able to connect to the Samba host.</para> +		<term><anchor id="LANMANAUTH"/>lanman auth (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will attempt to authenticate users  +		using the LANMAN password hash.	If disabled, only clients which support NT  +		password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000 clients, smbclient, etc... but not  +		Windows 95/98 or the MS DOS network client) will be able to connect to the Samba host.</para>  		<para>Default : <command>lanman auth = yes</command></para>  		</listitem> @@ -3405,9 +3400,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LARGEREADWRITE">large readwrite (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> -		supports the new 64k streaming read and write varient SMB requests introduced +		<term><anchor id="LARGEREADWRITE"/>large readwrite (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>	supports the new 64k streaming  +		read and write varient SMB requests introduced  		with Windows 2000. Note that due to Windows 2000 client redirector bugs  		this requires Samba to be running on a 64-bit capable operating system such  		as IRIX, Solaris or a Linux 2.4 kernel. Can improve performance by 10% with @@ -3422,14 +3418,15 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPADMINDN"/>ldap admin dn (G)</term>  		<listitem><para> The <parameter>ldap admin dn</parameter> defines the Distinguished   		Name (DN) name used by Samba to contact the ldap server when retreiving   		user account information. The <parameter>ldap  		admin dn</parameter> is used in conjunction with the admin dn password  		stored in the <filename>private/secrets.tdb</filename> file.  See the -		<ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> man -		page for more information on how to accmplish this. +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page for more information on how  +		to accmplish this.  		</para> @@ -3441,7 +3438,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPFILTER">ldap filter (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPFILTER"/>ldap filter (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the RFC 2254 compliant LDAP search filter.  		The default is to match the login name with the <constant>uid</constant>   		attribute for all entries matching the <constant>sambaAccount</constant>		 @@ -3455,7 +3452,7 @@                  <varlistentry> -                <term><anchor id="LDAPPORT">ldap port (G)</term> +                <term><anchor id="LDAPPORT"/>ldap port (G)</term>                  <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been                  configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option                  at compile time. @@ -3477,7 +3474,7 @@                  <varlistentry> -                <term><anchor id="LDAPSERVER">ldap server (G)</term> +                <term><anchor id="LDAPSERVER"/>ldap server (G)</term>                  <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been                  configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option                  at compile time. @@ -3494,7 +3491,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPSSL">ldap ssl (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPSSL"/>ldap ssl (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option is used to define whether or not Samba should  		use SSL when connecting to the ldap server  		This is <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> related to @@ -3528,7 +3525,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPSUFFIX"/>ldap suffix (G)</term>  		<listitem>  		<para>Specifies where user and machine accounts are added to the tree. Can be overriden by <command>ldap user suffix</command> and <command>ldap machine suffix</command>. It also used as the base dn for all ldap searches. </para> @@ -3539,7 +3536,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPUSERSUFFIX">ldap user suffix (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"/>ldap user suffix (G)</term>  	        <listitem><para>It specifies where users are added to the tree.  		</para> @@ -3552,7 +3549,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX">ldap machine suffix (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"/>ldap machine suffix (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>It specifies where machines should be                   added to the ldap tree.  		</para> @@ -3564,7 +3561,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPPASSWDSYNC">ldap passwd sync (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"/>ldap passwd sync (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option is used to define whether  		or not Samba should sync the LDAP password with the NT  		and LM hashes for normal accounts (NOT for @@ -3588,7 +3585,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LDAPTRUSTIDS">ldap trust ids (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LDAPTRUSTIDS"/>ldap trust ids (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Normally, Samba validates each entry  		in the LDAP server against getpwnam().  This allows  		LDAP to be used for Samba with the unix system using @@ -3607,7 +3604,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LEVEL2OPLOCKS">level2 oplocks (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"/>level2 oplocks (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls whether Samba supports  		level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</para> @@ -3651,9 +3648,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LMANNOUNCE">lm announce (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"> -		<command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink> will produce Lanman announce  +		<term><anchor id="LMANNOUNCE"/>lm announce (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will produce Lanman announce   		broadcasts that are needed by OS/2 clients in order for them to see   		the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter can have three   		values, <constant>yes</constant>, <constant>no</constant>, or @@ -3678,7 +3675,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LMINTERVAL">lm interval (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LMINTERVAL"/>lm interval (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce   		broadcasts needed by OS/2 clients (see the <link linkend="LMANNOUNCE">  		<parameter>lm announce</parameter></link> parameter) then this  @@ -3698,7 +3695,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOADPRINTERS">load printers (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOADPRINTERS"/>load printers (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>A boolean variable that controls whether all   		printers in the printcap will be loaded for browsing by default.   		See the <link linkend="PRINTERSSECT">printers</link> section for  @@ -3711,9 +3708,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCALMASTER">local master (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This option allows <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command> -		nmbd(8)</command></ulink> to try and become a local master browser  +		<term><anchor id="LOCALMASTER"/>local master (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This option allows <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to try and become a local master browser   		on a subnet. If set to <constant>no</constant> then <command>  		nmbd</command> will not attempt to become a local master browser   		on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By @@ -3732,7 +3729,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCKDIR">lock dir (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOCKDIR"/>lock dir (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="LOCKDIRECTORY"><parameter>  		lock directory</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -3740,7 +3737,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCKDIRECTORY">lock directory (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOCKDIRECTORY"/>lock directory (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option specifies the directory where lock   		files will be placed.  The lock files are used to implement the   		<link linkend="MAXCONNECTIONS"><parameter>max connections</parameter> @@ -3754,7 +3751,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCKSPINCOUNT">lock spin count (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOCKSPINCOUNT"/>lock spin count (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the number of times  		that smbd should attempt to gain a byte range lock on the   		behalf of a client request.  Experiments have shown that @@ -3773,7 +3770,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCKSPINTIME">lock spin time (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOCKSPINTIME"/>lock spin time (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The time in microseconds that smbd should   		pause before attempting to gain a failed lock.  See  		<link linkend="LOCKSPINCOUNT"><parameter>lock spin  @@ -3787,7 +3784,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOCKING">locking (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOCKING"/>locking (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether or not locking will be   		performed by the server in response to lock requests from the   		client.</para> @@ -3815,7 +3812,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGFILE">log file (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGFILE"/>log file (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to override the name   		of the Samba log file (also known as the debug file).</para> @@ -3829,7 +3826,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGLEVEL">log level (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGLEVEL"/>log level (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a astring) allows   		the debug level (logging level) to be specified in the   		<filename>smb.conf</filename> file. This parameter has been @@ -3847,7 +3844,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGONDRIVE">logon drive (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGONDRIVE"/>logon drive (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the local path to   		which the home directory will be connected (see <link   		linkend="LOGONHOME"><parameter>logon home</parameter></link>)  @@ -3864,7 +3861,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGONHOME">logon home (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGONHOME"/>logon home (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the home directory   		location when a Win95/98 or NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC.    		It allows you to do </para> @@ -3906,7 +3903,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGONPATH">logon path (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGONPATH"/>logon path (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the home directory   		where roaming profiles (NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are   		stored.  Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has  @@ -3954,7 +3951,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LOGONSCRIPT">logon script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LOGONSCRIPT"/>logon script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or   		NT command file (.cmd) to be downloaded and run on a machine when   		a user successfully logs in.  The file must contain the DOS  @@ -3996,7 +3993,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LPPAUSECOMMAND">lppause command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LPPAUSECOMMAND"/>lppause command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to stop printing or spooling   		a specific print job.</para> @@ -4040,7 +4037,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LPQCACHETIME">lpq cache time (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LPQCACHETIME"/>lpq cache time (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls how long lpq info will be cached   		for to prevent the <command>lpq</command> command being called too   		often. A separate cache is kept for each variation of the <command> @@ -4069,7 +4066,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LPQCOMMAND">lpq command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LPQCOMMAND"/>lpq command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to obtain <command>lpq  		</command>-style printer status information.</para> @@ -4113,7 +4110,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LPRESUMECOMMAND">lpresume command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LPRESUMECOMMAND"/>lpresume command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to restart or continue   		printing or spooling a specific print job.</para> @@ -4153,7 +4150,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="LPRMCOMMAND">lprm command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="LPRMCOMMAND"/>lprm command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to delete a print job.</para> @@ -4183,7 +4180,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT">machine password timeout (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"/>machine password timeout (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If a Samba server is a member of a Windows   		NT Domain (see the <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">security = domain</link>)   		parameter) then periodically a running <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> @@ -4193,8 +4190,8 @@  		will be changed, in seconds. The default is one week (expressed in   		seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member server.</para> -		<para>See also <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8) -		</command></ulink>, and the <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"> +		<para>See also <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and the <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">  		security = domain</link>) parameter.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>machine password timeout = 604800</command></para> @@ -4203,7 +4200,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAGICOUTPUT">magic output (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAGICOUTPUT"/>magic output (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a file   		which will contain output created by a magic script (see the   		<link linkend="MAGICSCRIPT"><parameter>magic script</parameter></link> @@ -4223,7 +4220,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAGICSCRIPT">magic script (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAGICSCRIPT"/>magic script (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a file which,   		if opened, will be executed by the server when the file is closed.   		This allows a UNIX script to be sent to the Samba host and  @@ -4254,7 +4251,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLECASE">mangle case (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLECASE"/>mangle case (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">  		NAME MANGLING</link></para> @@ -4264,7 +4261,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDMAP">mangled map (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDMAP"/>mangled map (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is for those who want to directly map UNIX   		file names which cannot be represented on Windows/DOS.  The mangling   		of names is not always what is needed.  In particular you may have  @@ -4289,7 +4286,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDNAMES">mangled names (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDNAMES"/>mangled names (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX   		should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible,   		or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</para> @@ -4348,7 +4345,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLINGMETHOD">mangling method (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLINGMETHOD"/>mangling method (G)</term>  		<listitem><para> controls the algorithm used for the generating  		the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and  		"hash2". "hash" is  the default and is the algorithm that has been @@ -4363,7 +4360,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLEPREFIX">mangle prefix (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLEPREFIX"/>mangle prefix (G)</term>  		<listitem><para> controls the number of prefix  		characters from the original name used when generating  		the mangled names. A larger value will give a weaker @@ -4375,10 +4372,10 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDSTACK">mangled stack (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLEDSTACK"/>mangled stack (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls the number of mangled names  -		that should be cached in the Samba server <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		smbd(8)</ulink>.</para> +		that should be cached in the Samba server <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  		<para>This stack is a list of recently mangled base names   		(extensions are only maintained if they are longer than 3 characters  @@ -4402,7 +4399,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MANGLINGCHAR">mangling char (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MANGLINGCHAR"/>mangling char (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls what character is used as   		the <emphasis>magic</emphasis> character in <link   		linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">name mangling</link>. The default is a '~' @@ -4419,7 +4416,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAPARCHIVE">map archive (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAPARCHIVE"/>map archive (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether the DOS archive attribute   		should be mapped to the UNIX owner execute bit.  The DOS archive bit   		is set when a file has been modified since its last backup.  One  @@ -4439,7 +4436,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAPHIDDEN">map hidden (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAPHIDDEN"/>map hidden (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether DOS style hidden files   		should be mapped to the UNIX world execute bit.</para> @@ -4454,7 +4451,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAPSYSTEM">map system (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAPSYSTEM"/>map system (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls whether DOS style system files   		should be mapped to the UNIX group execute bit.</para> @@ -4469,14 +4466,15 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAPTOGUEST">map to guest (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAPTOGUEST"/>map to guest (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is only useful in <link linkend="SECURITY">  		security</link> modes other than <parameter>security = share</parameter>   		- i.e. <constant>user</constant>, <constant>server</constant>,   		and <constant>domain</constant>.</para>  		<para>This parameter can take three different values, which tell -		<ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> what to do with user  +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> what to do with user   		login requests that don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.</para>  		<para>The three settings are :</para> @@ -4524,7 +4522,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXCONNECTIONS">max connections (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXCONNECTIONS"/>max connections (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows the number of simultaneous   		connections to a service to be limited. If <parameter>max connections  		</parameter> is greater than 0 then connections will be refused if  @@ -4544,7 +4542,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXDISKSIZE">max disk size (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXDISKSIZE"/>max disk size (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to put an upper limit   		on the apparent size of disks. If you set this option to 100   		then all shares will appear to be not larger than 100 MB in  @@ -4571,7 +4569,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXLOGSIZE">max log size (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXLOGSIZE"/>max log size (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies   		the max size the log file should grow to. Samba periodically checks   		the size and if it is exceeded it will rename the file, adding  @@ -4587,7 +4585,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXMUX">max mux (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXMUX"/>max mux (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option controls the maximum number of   		outstanding simultaneous SMB operations that Samba tells the client   		it will allow. You should never need to set this parameter.</para> @@ -4599,9 +4597,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXOPENFILES">max open files (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXOPENFILES"/>max open files (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of  -		open files that one <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> file  +		open files that one <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> file   		serving process may have open for a client at any one time. The   		default for this parameter is set very high (10,000) as Samba uses   		only one bit per unopened file.</para> @@ -4617,11 +4616,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXPRINTJOBS">max print jobs (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXPRINTJOBS"/>max print jobs (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of   		jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment. -		If this number is exceeded, <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command> -		smbd(8)</command></ulink> will remote "Out of Space" to the client. +		If this number is exceeded, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.  		See all <link linkend="TOTALPRINTJOBS"><parameter>total  		print jobs</parameter></link>.  		</para> @@ -4633,7 +4632,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXPROTOCOL">max protocol (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXPROTOCOL"/>max protocol (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest   		protocol level that will be supported by the server.</para> @@ -4671,14 +4670,15 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXSMBDPROCESSES">max smbd processes (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"/>max smbd processes (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of   		<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>  		processes concurrently running on a system and is intended  		as a stopgap to prevent degrading service to clients in the event  		that the server has insufficient resources to handle more than this  		number of connections.  Remember that under normal operating -		conditions, each user will have an <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> associated with him or her +		conditions, each user will have an <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> associated with him or her  		to handle connections to all shares from a given host.  		</para> @@ -4691,8 +4691,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXTTL">max ttl (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> +		<term><anchor id="MAXTTL"/>max ttl (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This option tells <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>  		what the default 'time to live' of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds)   		when <command>nmbd</command> is requesting a name using either a  		broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should never need to @@ -4705,9 +4706,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXWINSTTL">max wins ttl (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8) -		</ulink> when acting as a WINS server (<link linkend="WINSSUPPORT"> +		<term><anchor id="MAXWINSTTL"/>max wins ttl (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This option tells <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> when acting as a WINS server (<link linkend="WINSSUPPORT">  		<parameter>wins support = yes</parameter></link>) what the maximum  		'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <command>nmbd</command>   		will grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this @@ -4723,7 +4724,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MAXXMIT">max xmit (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MAXXMIT"/>max xmit (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option controls the maximum packet size   		that will be negotiated by Samba. The default is 65535, which   		is the maximum. In some cases you may find you get better performance  @@ -4738,7 +4739,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MESSAGECOMMAND">message command (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MESSAGECOMMAND"/>message command (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This specifies what command to run when the   		server receives a WinPopup style message.</para> @@ -4748,13 +4749,13 @@  		<para>An example is:</para> -		<para><command>message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &</command> +		<para><command>message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &</command>  		</para>  		<para>This delivers the message using <command>xedit</command>, then   		removes it afterwards. <emphasis>NOTE THAT IT IS VERY IMPORTANT   		THAT THIS COMMAND RETURN IMMEDIATELY</emphasis>. That's why I  -		have the '&' on the end. If it doesn't return immediately then  +		have the '&' on the end. If it doesn't return immediately then   		your PCs may freeze when sending messages (they should recover   		after 30 seconds, hopefully).</para> @@ -4799,7 +4800,7 @@  		<para>Default: <emphasis>no message command</emphasis></para>  		<para>Example: <command>message command = csh -c 'xedit %s; -		rm %s' &</command></para> +		rm %s' &</command></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -4807,7 +4808,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MINPASSWDLENGTH">min passwd length (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MINPASSWDLENGTH"/>min passwd length (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="MINPASSWORDLENGTH">  		<parameter>min password length</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -4816,7 +4817,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MINPASSWORDLENGTH">min password length (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MINPASSWORDLENGTH"/>min password length (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option sets the minimum length in characters   		of a plaintext password that <command>smbd</command> will accept when performing   		UNIX password changing.</para> @@ -4834,7 +4835,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MINPRINTSPACE">min print space (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MINPRINTSPACE"/>min print space (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This sets the minimum amount of free disk   		space that must be available before a user will be able to spool   		a print job. It is specified in kilobytes. The default is 0, which  @@ -4852,7 +4853,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MINPROTOCOL">min protocol (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MINPROTOCOL"/>min protocol (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a string) is the   		lowest SMB protocol dialect than Samba will support.  Please refer  		to the <link linkend="MAXPROTOCOL"><parameter>max protocol</parameter></link> @@ -4876,8 +4877,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MINWINSTTL">min wins ttl (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> +		<term><anchor id="MINWINSTTL"/>min wins ttl (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This option tells <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>  		when acting as a WINS server (<link linkend="WINSSUPPORT"><parameter>  		wins support = yes</parameter></link>) what the minimum 'time to live'   		of NetBIOS names that <command>nmbd</command> will grant will be (in  @@ -4890,7 +4892,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MSDFSPROXY">msdfs proxy (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MSDFSPROXY"/>msdfs proxy (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter indicates that the share is a  		stand-in for another CIFS share whose location is specified by  		the value of the parameter. When clients attempt to connect to @@ -4901,7 +4903,7 @@  		and  		<link linkend="HOSTMSDFS"><parameter>host msdfs</parameter></link>  		options to find out how to set up a Dfs root share.</para> -		<para>Example: <command>msdfs proxy = \otherserver\someshare</command></para> +		<para>Example: <command>msdfs proxy = \\\\otherserver\\someshare</command></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -4909,17 +4911,17 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="MSDFSROOT">msdfs root (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="MSDFSROOT"/>msdfs root (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available if   		Samba is configured  and  compiled with the <command>  		--with-msdfs</command> option.  If set to <constant>yes</constant>,   		Samba treats the share as a Dfs root and  allows clients to browse   		the distributed file system tree rooted at the share directory.   		Dfs links are specified  in  the share directory by symbolic  -		links of the form <filename>msdfs:serverA\shareA,serverB\shareB</filename> +		links of the form <filename>msdfs:serverA\\shareA,serverB\\shareB</filename>  		and so on.  For more information on setting up a Dfs tree  -		on Samba,  refer to <ulink url="msdfs_setup.html">msdfs_setup.html -		</ulink>.</para> +		on Samba,  refer to <ulink url="msdfs.html">"Hosting a Microsoft  +		Distributed File System tree on Samba"</ulink> document.</para>  		<para>See also <link linkend="HOSTMSDFS"><parameter>host msdfs  		</parameter></link></para> @@ -4929,7 +4931,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NAMECACHETIMEOUT">name cache timeout (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"/>name cache timeout (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before   		entries in samba's hostname resolve cache time out. If   		the timeout is set to 0. the caching is disabled. @@ -4942,7 +4944,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  -		<term><anchor id="NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NAMERESOLVEORDER"/>name resolve order (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option is used by the programs in the Samba   		suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order   		to resolve host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space  @@ -4995,7 +4997,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSALIASES">netbios aliases (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSALIASES"/>netbios aliases (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of NetBIOS names that <ulink   		url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> will advertise as additional   		names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine  @@ -5016,7 +5018,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSNAME">netbios name (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSNAME"/>netbios name (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba   		server is known. By default it is the same as the first component   		of the host's DNS name. If a machine is a browse server or @@ -5035,7 +5037,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSSCOPE">netbios scope (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NETBIOSSCOPE"/>netbios scope (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will   		operate under. This should not be set unless every machine   		on your LAN also sets this value.</para> @@ -5044,7 +5046,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NISHOMEDIR">nis homedir (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NISHOMEDIR"/>nis homedir (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For   		UNIX systems that use an automounter, the user's home directory   		will often be mounted on a workstation on demand from a remote  @@ -5077,7 +5079,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE">non unix account range (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"/>non unix account range (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The non unix account range parameter specifies                   the range of 'user ids' that are allocated by the various 'non unix                   account' passdb backends.  These backends allow @@ -5101,7 +5103,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NTACLSUPPORT">nt acl support (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NTACLSUPPORT"/>nt acl support (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether   		<ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will attempt to map   		UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. @@ -5115,9 +5117,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NTPIPESUPPORT">nt pipe support (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NTPIPESUPPORT"/>nt pipe support (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether  -		<ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will allow Windows NT  +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will allow Windows NT   		clients to connect to the NT SMB specific <constant>IPC$</constant>   		pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left  		alone.</para> @@ -5129,7 +5132,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NTSTATUSSUPPORT">nt status support (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"/>nt status support (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether <ulink  		url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will negotiate NT specific status  		support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. This is a developer @@ -5146,11 +5149,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NULLPASSWORDS">null passwords (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="NULLPASSWORDS"/>null passwords (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Allow or disallow client access to accounts   		that have null passwords. </para> -		<para>See also <ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html">smbpasswd (5)</ulink>.</para> +		<para>See also <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>null passwords = no</command></para>  		</listitem> @@ -5160,7 +5164,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS">obey pam restrictions (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"/>obey pam restrictions (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>When Samba 2.2 is configured to enable PAM support  		(i.e. --with-pam), this parameter will control whether or not Samba  		should obey PAM's account and session management directives.  The  @@ -5181,7 +5185,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ONLYUSER">only user (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ONLYUSER"/>only user (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean option that controls whether   		connections with usernames not in the <parameter>user</parameter>   		list will be allowed. By default this option is disabled so that a  @@ -5209,7 +5213,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ONLYGUEST">only guest (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ONLYGUEST"/>only guest (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>A synonym for <link linkend="GUESTONLY"><parameter>  		guest only</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -5218,7 +5222,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME">oplock break wait time (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"/>oplock break wait time (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in   		both Windows 9x and WinNT. If Samba responds to a client too   		quickly when that client issues an SMB that can cause an oplock  @@ -5236,15 +5240,15 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT">oplock contention limit (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"/>oplock contention limit (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a <emphasis>very</emphasis> advanced   		<ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> tuning option to   		improve the efficiency of the granting of oplocks under multiple   		client contention for the same file.</para> -		<para>In brief it specifies a number, which causes <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> not to  -		grant an oplock even when requested if the approximate number of  -		clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this  +		<para>In brief it specifies a number, which causes <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>not to grant an oplock even when requested  +		if the approximate number of clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this   		limit. This causes <command>smbd</command> to behave in a similar   		way to Windows NT.</para> @@ -5260,7 +5264,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKS">oplocks (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OPLOCKS"/>oplocks (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean option tells <command>smbd</command> whether to   		issue oplocks (opportunistic locks) to file open requests on this   		share. The oplock code can dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve  @@ -5288,13 +5292,16 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="NTLMAUTH">ntlm auth (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will +		<term><anchor id="NTLMAUTH"/>ntlm auth (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines  +		whether or not <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will  		attempt to authenticate users using the NTLM password hash.  		If disabled, only the lanman password hashes will be used.   		</para> -		<para>Please note that at least this option or <command>lanman auth</command> should be enabled in order to be able to log in. +		<para>Please note that at least this option or <command>lanman auth</command> should  +		be enabled in order to be able to log in.  		</para>  		<para>Default : <command>ntlm auth = yes</command></para> @@ -5302,10 +5309,11 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OSLEVEL">os level (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OSLEVEL"/>os level (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This integer value controls what level Samba   		advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this  -		parameter determines whether <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>  +		parameter determines whether <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>   		has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <parameter>  		WORKGROUP</parameter> in the local broadcast area.</para> @@ -5325,7 +5333,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="OS2DRIVERMAP">os2 driver map (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="OS2DRIVERMAP"/>os2 driver map (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The parameter is used to define the absolute  		path to a file containing a mapping of Windows NT printer driver  		names to OS/2 printer driver names.  The format is:</para> @@ -5338,10 +5346,9 @@  		LaserJet 5L</command>.</para>  		<para>The need for the file is due to the printer driver namespace  -		problem described in the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba  +		problem described in the <ulink url="printing.html">Samba   		Printing HOWTO</ulink>.  For more details on OS/2 clients, please  -		refer to the <ulink url="OS2-Client-HOWTO.html">OS2-Client-HOWTO -		</ulink> containing in the Samba documentation.</para> +		refer to the OS2-Client-HOWTO containing in the Samba documentation.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>os2 driver map = <empty string>  		</command></para> @@ -5350,7 +5357,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">pam password change (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"/>pam password change (G)</term>    		<listitem><para>With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2,     		this parameter, it is possible to use PAM's password change control     		flag for Samba.  If enabled, then PAM will be used for password @@ -5368,12 +5375,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PANICACTION">panic action (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PANICACTION"/>panic action (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a Samba developer option that allows a  -		system command to be called when either <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		smbd(8)</ulink> or <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>  -		crashes. This is usually used to draw attention to the fact that  -		a problem occurred.</para> +		system command to be called when either <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> or <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>	crashes. This is usually used to  +		draw attention to the fact that a problem occurred.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>panic action = <empty string></command></para>  		<para>Example: <command>panic action = "/bin/sleep 90000"</command></para> @@ -5381,7 +5388,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY">paranoid server security (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"/>paranoid server security (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest   		users with a bad passowrd. When this option is enabled, samba will not   		use a broken NT 4.x server as password server, but instead complain @@ -5394,7 +5401,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSDBBACKEND">passdb backend (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSDBBACKEND"/>passdb backend (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows the administrator to chose which backends to retrieve and store passwords with. This allows (for example) both                   smbpasswd and tdbsam to be used without a recompile.                   Multiple backends can be specified, separated by spaces. The backends will be searched in the order they are specified. New users are always added to the first backend specified. @@ -5487,13 +5494,13 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSWDCHAT">passwd chat (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSWDCHAT"/>passwd chat (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This string controls the <emphasis>"chat"</emphasis>  -		conversation that takes places between <ulink  -		url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> and the local password changing +		conversation that takes places between <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and the local password changing  		program to change the user's password. The string describes a  -		sequence of response-receive pairs that <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		smbd(8)</ulink> uses to determine what to send to the  +		sequence of response-receive pairs that <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> uses to determine what to send to the   		<link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd program</parameter>  		</link> and what to expect back. If the expected output is not   		received then the password is not changed.</para> @@ -5515,8 +5522,8 @@  		<para>The string can contain the macro <parameter>%n</parameter> which is substituted   		for the new password.  The chat sequence can also contain the standard  -		macros <constant>\n</constant>, <constant>\r</constant>, <constant> -		\t</constant> and <constant>\s</constant> to give line-feed,  +		macros <constant>\\n</constant>, <constant>\\r</constant>, <constant> +		\\t</constant> and <constant>\\s</constant> to give line-feed,   		carriage-return, tab and space.  The chat sequence string can also contain   		a '*' which matches any sequence of characters.  		Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces  @@ -5538,10 +5545,10 @@  		<parameter>passwd chat debug</parameter></link> and <link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">  		<parameter>pam password change</parameter></link>.</para> -		<para>Default: <command>passwd chat = *new*password* %n\n  -		*new*password* %n\n *changed*</command></para> -		<para>Example: <command>passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\n  -		"*Enter NEW password*" %n\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\n "*Password  +		<para>Default: <command>passwd chat = *new*password* %n\\n  +		*new*password* %n\\n *changed*</command></para> +		<para>Example: <command>passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\\n  +		"*Enter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Password   		changed*"</command></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -5549,11 +5556,12 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSWDCHATDEBUG">passwd chat debug (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"/>passwd chat debug (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script   		parameter is run in <emphasis>debug</emphasis> mode. In this mode the   		strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed  -		in the <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> log with a  +		in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> log with a   		<link linkend="DEBUGLEVEL"><parameter>debug level</parameter></link>   		of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords   		to be seen in the <command>smbd</command> log. It is available to help  @@ -5576,7 +5584,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSWDPROGRAM"/>passwd program (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The name of a program that can be used to set   		UNIX user passwords.  Any occurrences of <parameter>%u</parameter>   		will be replaced with the user name. The user name is checked for  @@ -5614,7 +5622,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSWORDLEVEL">password level (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSWORDLEVEL"/>password level (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Some client/server combinations have difficulty   		with mixed-case passwords.  One offending client is Windows for   		Workgroups, which for some reason forces passwords to upper  @@ -5657,7 +5665,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PASSWORDSERVER">password server (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PASSWORDSERVER"/>password server (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>By specifying the name of another SMB server (such   		as a WinNT box) with this option, and using <command>security = domain  		</command> or <command>security = server</command> you can get Samba  @@ -5752,7 +5760,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PATH">path (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PATH"/>path (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies a directory to which   		the user of the service is to be given access. In the case of   		printable services, this is where print data will spool prior to  @@ -5783,7 +5791,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PIDDIRECTORY">pid directory (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PIDDIRECTORY"/>pid directory (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option specifies the directory where pid   		files will be placed.  </para> @@ -5795,8 +5803,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="POSIXLOCKING">posix locking (S)</term> -		<listitem><para>The <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> +		<term><anchor id="POSIXLOCKING"/>posix locking (S)</term> +		<listitem><para>The <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>  		daemon maintains an database of file locks obtained by SMB clients.  		The default behavior is to map this internal database to POSIX  		locks.  This means that file locks obtained by SMB clients are  @@ -5812,7 +5821,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="POSTEXEC">postexec (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="POSTEXEC"/>postexec (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option specifies a command to be run   		whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual   		substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some  @@ -5837,7 +5846,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="POSTSCRIPT">postscript (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="POSTSCRIPT"/>postscript (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter forces a printer to interpret   		the print files as PostScript. This is done by adding a <constant>%!  		</constant> to the start of print output.</para> @@ -5853,7 +5862,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PREEXEC">preexec (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PREEXEC"/>preexec (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option specifies a command to be run whenever   		the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</para> @@ -5862,12 +5871,12 @@  		is an example:</para>  		<para><command>preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" | -		 /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' & </command></para> +		 /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' & </command></para>  		<para>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</para>  		<para>See also <link linkend="PREEXECCLOSE"><parameter>preexec close -		</parameter</link> and <link linkend="POSTEXEC"><parameter>postexec +		</parameter></link> and <link linkend="POSTEXEC"><parameter>postexec  		</parameter></link>.</para>  		<para>Default: <emphasis>none (no command executed)</emphasis></para> @@ -5879,7 +5888,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PREEXECCLOSE">preexec close (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PREEXECCLOSE"/>preexec close (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero   		return code from <link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>preexec  		</parameter></link> should close the service being connected to.</para> @@ -5890,7 +5899,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PREFERREDMASTER">preferred master (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PREFERREDMASTER"/>preferred master (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls if <ulink   		url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> is a preferred master browser   		for its workgroup.</para> @@ -5919,7 +5928,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PREFEREDMASTER">prefered master (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PREFEREDMASTER"/>prefered master (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PREFERREDMASTER"><parameter>  		preferred master</parameter></link> for people who cannot spell :-).</para>  		</listitem> @@ -5928,7 +5937,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRELOAD">preload (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRELOAD"/>preload (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of services that you want to be   		automatically added to the browse lists. This is most useful   		for homes and printers services that would otherwise not be  @@ -5946,7 +5955,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRESERVECASE">preserve case (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRESERVECASE"/>preserve case (S)</term>  		<listitem><para> This controls if new filenames are created  		with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to   		be the <link linkend="DEFAULTCASE"><parameter>default case @@ -5962,7 +5971,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTCOMMAND">print command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTCOMMAND"/>print command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>After a print job has finished spooling to   		a service, this command will be used via a <command>system()</command>   		call to process the spool file. Typically the command specified will  @@ -6052,7 +6061,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTOK">print ok (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTOK"/>print ok (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PRINTABLE">  		<parameter>printable</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6062,7 +6071,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTABLE">printable (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTABLE"/>printable (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant>, then   		clients may open, write to and submit spool files on the directory   		specified for the service. </para> @@ -6080,7 +6089,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTCAP">printcap (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTCAP"/>printcap (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for 	<link linkend="PRINTCAPNAME"><parameter>  		printcap name</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6090,7 +6099,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTCAPNAME">printcap name (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTCAPNAME"/>printcap name (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter may be used to override the   		compiled-in default printcap name used by the server (usually <filename>  		/etc/printcap</filename>). See the discussion of the <link @@ -6116,13 +6125,13 @@  		<para>A minimal printcap file would look something like this:</para> -		<para><programlisting> -		print1|My Printer 1 -		print2|My Printer 2 -		print3|My Printer 3 -		print4|My Printer 4 -		print5|My Printer 5 -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +print1|My Printer 1 +print2|My Printer 2 +print3|My Printer 3 +print4|My Printer 4 +print5|My Printer 5 +</programlisting></para>  		<para>where the '|' separates aliases of a printer. The fact   		that the second alias has a space in it gives a hint to Samba  @@ -6143,7 +6152,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTERADMIN">printer admin (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTERADMIN"/>printer admin (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users that can do anything to   		printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC   		(usually using a NT workstation). Note that the root user always  @@ -6160,11 +6169,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVER">printer driver (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVER"/>printer driver (S)</term>  		<listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated   		parameter and will be removed in the next major release  		following version 2.2.  Please see the instructions in -		the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing +		the <ulink url="printing.html">Samba 2.2. Printing  		HOWTO</ulink> for more information  		on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.  		</para> @@ -6193,11 +6202,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERFILE">printer driver file (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERFILE"/>printer driver file (G)</term>  		<listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated   		parameter and will be removed in the next major release  		following version 2.2.  Please see the instructions in -		the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing +		the <ulink url="printing.html">Samba 2.2. Printing  		HOWTO</ulink> for more information  		on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.  		</para> @@ -6229,11 +6238,11 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION">printer driver location (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"/>printer driver location (S)</term>  		<listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated   		parameter and will be removed in the next major release  		following version 2.2.  Please see the instructions in -		the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing +		the <ulink url="printing.html">Samba 2.2. Printing  		HOWTO</ulink> for more information  		on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.  		</para> @@ -6263,7 +6272,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTERNAME">printer name (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTERNAME"/>printer name (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of the printer   		to which print jobs spooled through a printable service will be sent.</para> @@ -6280,7 +6289,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTER">printer (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTER"/>printer (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PRINTERNAME"><parameter>  		printer name</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6289,7 +6298,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRINTING">printing (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRINTING"/>printing (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameters controls how printer status   		information is interpreted on your system. It also affects the   		default values for the <parameter>print command</parameter>,  @@ -6320,7 +6329,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PRIVATEDIR">private dir (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PRIVATEDIR"/>private dir (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameters defines the directory  		smbd will use for storing such files as <filename>smbpasswd</filename>  		and <filename>secrets.tdb</filename>. @@ -6334,7 +6343,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PROTOCOL">protocol (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PROTOCOL"/>protocol (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="MAXPROTOCOL">  		<parameter>max protocol</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -6343,7 +6352,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="PUBLIC">public (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="PUBLIC"/>public (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="GUESTOK"><parameter>guest   		ok</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6352,7 +6361,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND">queuepause command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"/>queuepause command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</para> @@ -6381,7 +6390,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND">queueresume command (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"/>queueresume command (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be   		executed on the server host in order to resume the printer queue. It    		is the command to undo the behavior that is caused by the  @@ -6416,7 +6425,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="READBMPX">read bmpx (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="READBMPX"/>read bmpx (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether <ulink   		url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will support the "Read   		Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to  @@ -6431,7 +6440,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="READLIST">read list (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="READLIST"/>read list (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users that are given read-only   		access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then   		they will not be given write access, no matter what the <link  @@ -6453,7 +6462,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="READONLY">read only (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="READONLY"/>read only (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>An inverted synonym is <link linkend="WRITEABLE">  		<parameter>writeable</parameter></link>.</para> @@ -6472,7 +6481,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="READRAW">read raw (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="READRAW"/>read raw (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not the server   		will support the raw read SMB requests when transferring data   		to clients.</para> @@ -6495,7 +6504,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="READSIZE">read size (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="READSIZE"/>read size (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The option <parameter>read size</parameter>   		affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with network reads/writes.   		If the amount of data being transferred in several of the SMB  @@ -6522,7 +6531,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="REALM">realm (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="REALM"/>realm (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>  		This option specifies the kerberos realm to use. The realm is   		used as the ADS equivalent of the NT4<command>domain</command>. It @@ -6535,7 +6544,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="REMOTEANNOUNCE">remote announce (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="REMOTEANNOUNCE"/>remote announce (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to setup <ulink   		url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> to periodically announce itself   		to arbitrary IP addresses with an arbitrary workgroup name.</para> @@ -6560,7 +6569,7 @@  		addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses   		of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</para> -		<para>See the documentation file <filename>BROWSING.txt</filename>  +		<para>See the documentation file <ulink url="improved-browsing.html">BROWSING</ulink>   		in the <filename>docs/</filename> directory.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>remote announce = <empty string> @@ -6571,7 +6580,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="REMOTEBROWSESYNC">remote browse sync (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"/>remote browse sync (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to setup <ulink   		url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> to periodically request   		synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba  @@ -6609,7 +6618,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="RESTRICTANONYMOUS">restrict anonymous (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"/>restrict anonymous (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a integer parameter, and  		mirrors as much as possible the functinality the  		<constant>RestrictAnonymous</constant> @@ -6622,7 +6631,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOT">root (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOT"/>root (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="ROOTDIRECTORY">  		<parameter>root directory"</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6631,7 +6640,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOTDIR">root dir (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOTDIR"/>root dir (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="ROOTDIRECTORY">  		<parameter>root directory"</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -6639,7 +6648,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOTDIRECTORY">root directory (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOTDIRECTORY"/>root directory (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The server will <command>chroot()</command> (i.e.   		Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is   		not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the  @@ -6671,7 +6680,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOTPOSTEXEC">root postexec (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOTPOSTEXEC"/>root postexec (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>postexec</parameter>  		parameter except that the command is run as root. This   		is useful for unmounting filesystems  @@ -6686,7 +6695,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXEC">root preexec (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXEC"/>root preexec (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>preexec</parameter>  		parameter except that the command is run as root. This   		is useful for mounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) when a  @@ -6704,7 +6713,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE">root preexec close (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"/>root preexec close (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>preexec close  		</parameter> parameter except that the command is run as root.</para> @@ -6718,14 +6727,14 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SECURITY">security (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SECURITY"/>security (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option affects how clients respond to   		Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <filename>  		smb.conf</filename> file.</para>  		<para>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to  -		protocol negotiations with <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8) -		</ulink> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide  +		protocol negotiations with <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide   		based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password   		information to the server.</para> @@ -6770,7 +6779,7 @@  		<para>The different settings will now be explained.</para> -		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"><emphasis>SECURITY = SHARE +		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"/><emphasis>SECURITY = SHARE  		</emphasis></para>   		<para>When clients connect to a share level security server they  @@ -6839,7 +6848,7 @@  		<para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">  		NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para> -		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"><emphasis>SECURITY = USER +		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"/><emphasis>SECURITY = USER  		</emphasis></para>  		<para>This is the default security setting in Samba 2.2.  @@ -6866,7 +6875,7 @@  		<para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">  		NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para> -		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"><emphasis>SECURITY = SERVER +		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"/><emphasis>SECURITY = SERVER  		</emphasis></para>  		<para>In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password  @@ -6902,11 +6911,11 @@  		linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter>  		</link> parameter.</para> -		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"><emphasis>SECURITY = DOMAIN +		<para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"/><emphasis>SECURITY = DOMAIN  		</emphasis></para> -		<para>This mode will only work correctly if <ulink  -		url="smbpasswd.8.html">smbpasswd(8)</ulink> has been used to add this  +		<para>This mode will only work correctly if <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> has been used to add this   		machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <link   		linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter>  		</link> parameter to be set to <constant>yes</constant>. In this  @@ -6956,7 +6965,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SECURITYMASK">security mask (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SECURITYMASK"/>security mask (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission   		bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating   		the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security  @@ -6991,7 +7000,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SERVERSTRING">server string (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SERVERSTRING"/>server string (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls what string will show up in the   		printer comment box in print manager and next to the IPC connection   		in <command>net view</command>. It can be any string that you wish  @@ -7016,7 +7025,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SETDIRECTORY">set directory (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SETDIRECTORY"/>set directory (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If <command>set directory = no</command>, then   		users of the service may not use the setdir command to change   		directory.</para> @@ -7032,7 +7041,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SHAREMODES">share modes (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SHAREMODES"/>share modes (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This enables or disables the honoring of   		the <parameter>share modes</parameter> during a file open. These   		modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access  @@ -7061,7 +7070,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SHORTPRESERVECASE">short preserve case (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SHORTPRESERVECASE"/>short preserve case (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls if new files   		which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of   		suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced  @@ -7081,7 +7090,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD">show add printer wizard (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"/>show add printer wizard (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support  		for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will   		appear on Samba hosts in the share listing.  Normally this folder will  @@ -7116,7 +7125,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT">shutdown script (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"/>shutdown script (G)</term>  		<listitem><para><emphasis>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</emphasis>  		This a full path name to a script called by  		<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> that @@ -7142,15 +7151,15 @@  		<para>Default: <emphasis>None</emphasis>.</para>  		<para>Example: <command>abort shutdown script = /usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f</command></para>  		<para>Shutdown script example: -		<programlisting> -		#!/bin/bash +<programlisting> +#!/bin/bash -		$time=0 -		let "time/60" -		let "time++" +$time=0 +let "time/60" +let "time++" -		/sbin/shutdown $3 $4 +$time $1 & -		</programlisting> +/sbin/shutdown $3 $4 +$time $1 & +</programlisting>  		Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background.  		</para> @@ -7160,7 +7169,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SMBPASSWDFILE">smb passwd file (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SMBPASSWDFILE"/>smb passwd file (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option sets the path to the encrypted    		smbpasswd file.  By default the path to the smbpasswd file   		is compiled into Samba.</para> @@ -7175,7 +7184,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SMBPORTS">smb ports (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SMBPORTS"/>smb ports (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies which ports the server should listen on  		for SMB traffic.  		</para> @@ -7186,7 +7195,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SOCKETADDRESS">socket address (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SOCKETADDRESS"/>socket address (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to control what   		address Samba will listen for connections on. This is used to   		support multiple virtual interfaces on the one server, each  @@ -7203,7 +7212,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SOCKETOPTIONS">socket options (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SOCKETOPTIONS"/>socket options (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to set socket options   		to be used when talking with the client.</para> @@ -7276,7 +7285,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SOURCEENVIRONMENT">source environment (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SOURCEENVIRONMENT"/>source environment (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter causes Samba to set environment   		variables as per the content of the file named.</para> @@ -7298,17 +7307,23 @@  		/usr/local/smb_env_vars</command></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> -<varlistentry> -<term><anchor id="SPNEGO">use spnego (G)</term> -<listitem><para> This variable controls controls whether samba will try to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with WindowsXP and Windows2000sp2 clients to agree upon an authentication mechanism.  As of samba 3.0alpha it must be set to "no" for these clients to join a samba domain controller.  It can be set to "yes" to allow samba to participate in an AD domain controlled by a Windows2000 domain controller.</para> -<para>Default:  <emphasis>use spnego = yes</emphasis></para> -</listitem> -</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STATCACHE">stat cache (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink  -		url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will use a cache in order to  +		<term><anchor id="SPNEGO"/>use spnego (G)</term> +		<listitem><para> This variable controls controls whether samba will try  +		to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with  +		WindowsXP and Windows2000sp2 clients to agree upon an authentication mechanism.  +		As of samba 3.0alpha it must be set to "no" for these clients to join a samba  +		domain controller.  It can be set to "yes" to allow samba to participate in an  +		AD domain controlled by a Windows2000 domain controller.</para> +		<para>Default:  <emphasis>use spnego = yes</emphasis></para> +		</listitem> +		</varlistentry> + +		<varlistentry> +		<term><anchor id="STATCACHE"/>stat cache (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will use a cache in order to   		speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need   		to change this parameter.</para> @@ -7317,7 +7332,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STATCACHESIZE">stat cache size (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="STATCACHESIZE"/>stat cache size (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter determines the number of   		entries in the <parameter>stat cache</parameter>.  You should   		never need to change this parameter.</para> @@ -7329,7 +7344,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STRICTALLOCATE">strict allocate (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="STRICTALLOCATE"/>strict allocate (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls the handling of   		disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <constant>yes</constant>   		the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real @@ -7353,7 +7368,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STRICTLOCKING">strict locking (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="STRICTLOCKING"/>strict locking (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls the handling of   		file locking in the server. When this is set to <constant>yes</constant>   		the server will check every read and write access for file locks, and  @@ -7373,7 +7388,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STRICTSYNC">strict sync (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="STRICTSYNC"/>strict sync (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Many Windows applications (including the Windows   		98 explorer shell) seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to   		disk with doing a sync to disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces  @@ -7381,7 +7396,8 @@  		all outstanding data in kernel disk buffers has been safely stored   		onto stable storage. This is very slow and should only be done   		rarely. Setting this parameter to <constant>no</constant> (the  -		default) means that <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> ignores the Windows applications requests for +		default) means that <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> ignores the Windows applications requests for  		a sync call. There is only a possibility of losing data if the  		operating system itself that Samba is running on crashes, so there is  		little danger in this default setting. In addition, this fixes many @@ -7397,7 +7413,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="STRIPDOT">strip dot (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="STRIPDOT"/>strip dot (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls whether to   		strip trailing dots off UNIX filenames. This helps with some   		CDROMs that have filenames ending in a single dot.</para> @@ -7409,7 +7425,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SYNCALWAYS">sync always (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SYNCALWAYS"/>sync always (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean parameter that controls   		whether writes will always be written to stable storage before   		the write call returns. If this is <constant>no</constant> then the server will be  @@ -7431,7 +7447,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SYSLOG">syslog (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SYSLOG"/>syslog (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter maps how Samba debug messages   		are logged onto the system syslog logging levels. Samba debug   		level zero maps onto syslog <constant>LOG_ERR</constant>, debug  @@ -7451,7 +7467,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="SYSLOGONLY">syslog only (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="SYSLOGONLY"/>syslog only (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this parameter is set then Samba debug   		messages are logged into the system syslog only, and not to   		the debug log files.</para> @@ -7463,7 +7479,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR">template homedir (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"/>template homedir (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT   		user, the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon   		uses this parameter to fill in the home directory for that user.   @@ -7479,9 +7495,10 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TEMPLATESHELL">template shell (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="TEMPLATESHELL"/>template shell (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT  -		user, the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon  +		user, the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon   		uses this parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</para>  		<para>Default: <command>template shell = /bin/false</command></para> @@ -7491,7 +7508,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TIMEOFFSET">time offset (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="TIMEOFFSET"/>time offset (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add   		to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if   		you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight  @@ -7505,9 +7522,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TIMESERVER">time server (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"> 			 -		nmbd(8)</ulink> advertises itself as a time server to Windows  +		<term><anchor id="TIMESERVER"/>time server (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter determines if <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> advertises itself as a time server to Windows   		clients.</para>    		<para>Default: <command>time server = no</command></para> @@ -7516,7 +7533,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TIMESTAMPLOGS">timestamp logs (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="TIMESTAMPLOGS"/>timestamp logs (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>  		debug timestamp</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -7527,16 +7544,17 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="TOTALPRINTJOBS">total print jobs (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="TOTALPRINTJOBS"/>total print jobs (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter accepts an integer value which defines  		a limit on the maximum number of print jobs that will be accepted   		system wide at any given time.  If a print job is submitted -		by a client which will exceed this number, then <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will return an  +		by a client which will exceed this number, then <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> will return an   		error indicating that no space is available on the server.  The   		default value of 0 means that no such limit exists.  This parameter  		can be used to prevent a server from exceeding its capacity and is  		designed as a printing throttle.  See also  -		<link linkend="MAXPRINTJOBS"><parameter>max print jobs</parameter</link>. +		<link linkend="MAXPRINTJOBS"><parameter>max print jobs</parameter></link>.  		</para>  		<para>Default: <command>total print jobs = 0</command></para> @@ -7545,7 +7563,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UNICODE">unicode (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UNICODE"/>unicode (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies whether Samba should try   		to use unicode on the wire by default. Note: This does NOT  		mean that samba will assume that the unix machine uses unicode! @@ -7557,19 +7575,19 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UNIXCHARSET">unix charset (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UNIXCHARSET"/>unix charset (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies the charset the unix machine   		Samba runs on uses. Samba needs to know this in order to be able to   		convert text to the charsets other SMB clients use.  		</para> -		<para>Default: <command>unix charset = ASCII</command></para> -		<para>Example: <command>unix charset = UTF8</command></para> +		<para>Default: <command>unix charset = UTF8</command></para> +		<para>Example: <command>unix charset = ASCII</command></para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UNIXEXTENSIONS">unix extensions(G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UNIXEXTENSIONS"/>unix extensions(G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba   		implments the CIFS UNIX extensions, as defined by HP.   		These extensions enable Samba to better serve UNIX CIFS clients @@ -7585,7 +7603,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC">unix password sync (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"/>unix password sync (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba   		attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password   		when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed.  @@ -7606,7 +7624,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UPDATEENCRYPTED">update encrypted (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UPDATEENCRYPTED"/>update encrypted (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter allows a user logging   		on with a plaintext password to have their encrypted (hashed)   		password in the smbpasswd file to be updated automatically as  @@ -7637,7 +7655,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USECLIENTDRIVER">use client driver (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USECLIENTDRIVER"/>use client driver (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000  		clients.  It has no affect on Windows 95/98/ME clients.  When   		serving a printer to Windows NT/2000 clients without first installing @@ -7675,7 +7693,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USEMMAP">use mmap (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USEMMAP"/>use mmap (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can  		depend on mmap working correctly on the running system. Samba requires a coherent  		mmap/read-write system memory cache. Currently only HPUX does not have such a @@ -7693,7 +7711,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USERHOSTS">use rhosts (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USERHOSTS"/>use rhosts (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this global parameter is <constant>yes</constant>, it specifies   		that the UNIX user's <filename>.rhosts</filename> file in their home directory   		will be read to find the names of hosts and users who will be allowed  @@ -7713,7 +7731,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USER">user (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USER"/>user (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="USERNAME"><parameter>  		username</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -7722,7 +7740,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USERS">users (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USERS"/>users (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="USERNAME"><parameter>  		username</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -7730,7 +7748,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USERNAME">username (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USERNAME"/>username (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited   		list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against   		each username in turn (left to right).</para> @@ -7771,7 +7789,7 @@  		will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will   		expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</para> -		<para>If any of the usernames begin with a '&'then the name  +		<para>If any of the usernames begin with a '&' then the name   		will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba   		is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list   		of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</para> @@ -7795,7 +7813,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USERNAMELEVEL">username level (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USERNAMELEVEL"/>username level (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at   		the real UNIX username, as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase   		username. By default Samba tries all lowercase, followed by the  @@ -7818,7 +7836,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USERNAMEMAP">username map (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USERNAMEMAP"/>username map (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This option allows you to specify a file containing   		a mapping of usernames from the clients to the server. This can be   		used for several purposes. The most common is to map usernames  @@ -7881,10 +7899,10 @@  		'!' to tell Samba to stop processing if it gets a match on  		that line.</para> -		<para><programlisting> -		!sys = mary fred -		guest = * -		</programlisting></para> +<para><programlisting> +!sys = mary fred +guest = * +</programlisting></para>  		<para>Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences  		of usernames. Thus if you connect to \\server\fred and <constant> @@ -7910,7 +7928,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="USESENDFILE">use sendfile (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="USESENDFILE"/>use sendfile (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant>, and Samba  		was built with the --with-sendfile-support option, and the underlying operating  		system supports sendfile system call, then some SMB read calls (mainly ReadAndX @@ -7927,7 +7945,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UTMP">utmp (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UTMP"/>utmp (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available if  		Samba has been configured and compiled  with the option <command>  		--with-utmp</command>. If set to <constant>yes</constant> then Samba will attempt @@ -7949,7 +7967,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="UTMPDIRECTORY">utmp directory(G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="UTMPDIRECTORY"/>utmp directory(G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has   		been configured and compiled with the option <command>  		--with-utmp</command>. It specifies a directory pathname that is @@ -7966,7 +7984,7 @@  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WTMPDIRECTORY">wtmp directory(G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WTMPDIRECTORY"/>wtmp directory(G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has   		been configured and compiled with the option <command>  		--with-utmp</command>. It specifies a directory pathname that is @@ -7988,9 +8006,9 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VALIDUSERS">valid users (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VALIDUSERS"/>valid users (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users that should be allowed  -		to login to this service. Names starting with '@', '+' and  '&' +		to login to this service. Names starting with '@', '+' and  '&'  		are interpreted using the same rules as described in the   		<parameter>invalid users</parameter> parameter.</para> @@ -8015,7 +8033,7 @@  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VETOFILES">veto files(S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VETOFILES"/>veto files(S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of files and directories that   		are neither visible nor accessible.  Each entry in the list must   		be separated by a '/', which allows spaces to be included  @@ -8063,7 +8081,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VETOOPLOCKFILES">veto oplock files (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VETOOPLOCKFILES"/>veto oplock files (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter is only valid when the <link  		linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link>  		parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator @@ -8089,7 +8107,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VFSPATH">vfs path (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VFSPATH"/>vfs path (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the directory  		to look in for vfs modules. The name of every <command>vfs object  		</command> will be prepended by this directory @@ -8102,7 +8120,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VFSOBJECT">vfs object (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VFSOBJECT"/>vfs object (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies a shared object files that   		are used for Samba VFS I/O operations.  By default, normal   		disk I/O operations are used but these can be overloaded  @@ -8116,7 +8134,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VFSOPTIONS">vfs options (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VFSOPTIONS"/>vfs options (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows parameters to be passed   		to the vfs layer at initialization time.   		See also <link linkend="VFSOBJECT"><parameter> @@ -8129,7 +8147,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="VOLUME">volume (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="VOLUME"/>volume (S)</term>  		<listitem><para> This allows you to override the volume label   		returned for a share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs   		that insist on a particular volume label.</para> @@ -8141,7 +8159,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WIDELINKS">wide links (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WIDELINKS"/>wide links (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not links   		in the UNIX file system may be followed by the server. Links   		that point to areas within the directory tree exported by the  @@ -8160,9 +8178,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDCACHETIME">winbind cache time (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the -		<ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon will cache  +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDCACHETIME"/>winbind cache time (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies the number of  +		seconds the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon will cache   		user and group information before querying a Windows NT server   		again.</para> @@ -8172,11 +8191,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMUSERS">winbind enum users (G)</term>  -		<listitem><para>On large installations using -		<ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> it may be -		necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the -		<command> setpwent()</command>, +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMUSERS"/>winbind enum users (G)</term>  +		<listitem><para>On large installations using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> it may be +		necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the <command>setpwent()</command>,  		<command>getpwent()</command> and  		<command>endpwent()</command> group of system calls.  If  		the <parameter>winbind enum users</parameter> parameter is @@ -8194,11 +8212,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMGROUPS">winbind enum groups (G)</term>  -		<listitem><para>On large installations using -		<ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> it may be -		necessary to suppress the enumeration of groups through the -		<command> setgrent()</command>, +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"/>winbind enum groups (G)</term>  +		<listitem><para>On large installations using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> it may be necessary to suppress  +		the enumeration of groups through the <command>setgrent()</command>,  		<command>getgrent()</command> and  		<command>endgrent()</command> group of system calls.  If  		the <parameter>winbind enum groups</parameter> parameter is @@ -8215,10 +8232,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDGID">winbind gid (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDGID"/>winbind gid (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group  -		ids that are allocated by the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html"> -		winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon.  This range of group ids should have no  +		ids that are allocated by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon.  This range of group ids should have no   		existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can   		occur otherwise.</para> @@ -8231,7 +8248,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDSEPARATOR">winbind separator (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDSEPARATOR"/>winbind separator (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter allows an admin to define the character   		used when listing a username of the form of <replaceable>DOMAIN  		</replaceable>\<replaceable>user</replaceable>.  This parameter  @@ -8252,10 +8269,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDUID">winbind uid (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDUID"/>winbind uid (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group  -		ids that are allocated by the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html"> -		winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon.  This range of ids should have no  +		ids that are allocated by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon.  This range of ids should have no   		existing local or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can   		occur otherwise.</para> @@ -8268,12 +8285,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term>winbind use default domain</term> -		 -		<term><anchor id="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN">winbind use default domain (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies whether the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html"> -		winbindd(8)</ulink> -		daemon should operate on users without domain component in their username.   +		<term><anchor id="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"/>winbind use default domain (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This parameter specifies whether the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon should operate on users  +		without domain component in their username.                    Users without a domain component are treated as is part of the winbindd server's                   own domain.  While this does not benifit Windows users, it makes SSH, FTP and e-mail                   function in a way much closer to the way they would in a native unix system.</para> @@ -8286,7 +8301,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINSHOOK">wins hook (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINSHOOK"/>wins hook (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>When Samba is running as a WINS server this   		allows you to call an external program for all changes to the   		WINS database. The primary use for this option is to allow the  @@ -8334,7 +8349,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINSPROXY">wins proxy (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINSPROXY"/>wins proxy (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls if <ulink   		url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> will respond to broadcast name   		queries on behalf of  other hosts. You may need to set this  @@ -8348,10 +8363,10 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINSSERVER">wins server (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINSSERVER"/>wins server (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP  -		address for preference) of the WINS server that <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"> -		nmbd(8)</ulink> should register with. If you have a WINS server on  +		address for preference) of the WINS server that <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> should register with. If you have a WINS server on   		your network then you should set this to the WINS server's IP.</para>  		<para>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a @@ -8361,7 +8376,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		to a WINS server if you have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet   		browsing to work correctly.</para> -		<para>See the documentation file <filename>BROWSING.txt</filename>  +		<para>See the documentation file <ulink url="improved-browsing.html">BROWSING</ulink>   		in the docs/ directory of your Samba source distribution.</para>  		<para>Default: <emphasis>not enabled</emphasis></para> @@ -8372,9 +8387,9 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINSSUPPORT">wins support (G)</term> -		<listitem><para>This boolean controls if the <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"> 		 -		nmbd(8)</ulink> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should  +		<term><anchor id="WINSSUPPORT"/>wins support (G)</term> +		<listitem><para>This boolean controls if the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should   		not set this to <constant>yes</constant> unless you have a multi-subnetted network and   		you wish a particular <command>nmbd</command> to be your WINS server.   		Note that you should <emphasis>NEVER</emphasis> set this to <constant>yes</constant> @@ -8387,7 +8402,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WORKGROUP">workgroup (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WORKGROUP"/>workgroup (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This controls what workgroup your server will   		appear to be in when queried by clients. Note that this parameter   		also controls the Domain name used with the <link  @@ -8403,7 +8418,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITABLE">writable (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITABLE"/>writable (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>  		writeable</parameter></link> for people who can't spell :-).</para>  		</listitem> @@ -8412,7 +8427,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITECACHESIZE">write cache size (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITECACHESIZE"/>write cache size (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,  		Samba will create an in-memory cache for each oplocked file   		(it does <emphasis>not</emphasis> do this for  @@ -8444,7 +8459,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITELIST">write list (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITELIST"/>write list (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>This is a list of users that are given read-write   		access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then   		they will be given write access, no matter what the <link @@ -8469,7 +8484,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WINSPARTNERS">wins partners (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WINSPARTNERS"/>wins partners (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>A space separated list of partners' IP addresses for   		WINS replication. WINS partners are always defined as push/pull   		partners as defining only one way WINS replication is unreliable.  @@ -8485,7 +8500,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITEOK">write ok (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITEOK"/>write ok (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Inverted synonym for <link linkend="READONLY"><parameter>  		read only</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -8494,7 +8509,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITERAW">write raw (G)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITERAW"/>write raw (G)</term>  		<listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not the server   		will support raw write SMB's when transferring data from clients.   		You should never need to change this parameter.</para> @@ -8506,7 +8521,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  		<varlistentry> -		<term><anchor id="WRITEABLE">writeable (S)</term> +		<term><anchor id="WRITEABLE"/>writeable (S)</term>  		<listitem><para>Inverted synonym for <link linkend="READONLY"><parameter>  		read only</parameter></link>.</para>  		</listitem> @@ -8526,8 +8541,8 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  	problem - but be aware of the possibility.</para>  	<para>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients -  -	limit service names to eight characters. <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8) -	</ulink> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such  +	limit service names to eight characters. <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such   	clients will fail if they truncate the service names.  For this reason   	you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters   	in length.</para> @@ -8542,22 +8557,22 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>, -	<ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink>, -	<ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command></ulink>, -	<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="nmblookup.1.html"><command>nmblookup(1)</command></ulink>, -	<ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command>testparm(1)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="testprns.1.html"><command>testprns(1)</command></ulink> -	</para> +	<para> +	<citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -8570,11 +8585,11 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcacls.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcacls.1.sgml index 766d2a78b1..5e0e6c80e9 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcacls.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcacls.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbcacls"> +<refentry id="smbcacls.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbcacls</refentrytitle> @@ -32,8 +32,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>The <command>smbcacls</command> program manipulates NT Access Control  	Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </para> @@ -90,7 +90,8 @@  		<listitem><para>Specifies a username used to connect to the   		specified service.  The username may be of the form "username" in   		which case the user is prompted to enter in a password and the  -		workgroup specified in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file is  +		workgroup specified in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file is   		used, or "username%password"  or "DOMAIN\username%password" and the   		password and workgroup names are used as provided. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -147,12 +148,12 @@  	<para>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by   	either commas or newlines.  An ACL entry is one of the following: </para> -	<para><programlisting>  +<para><programlisting>   REVISION:<revision number>  OWNER:<sid or name>  GROUP:<sid or name>  ACL:<sid or name>:<type>/<flags>/<mask> -	</programlisting></para> +</programlisting></para>  	<para>The revision of the ACL specifies the internal Windows  @@ -165,24 +166,22 @@ ACL:<sid or name>:<type>/<flags>/<mask>  	otherwise the name specified is resolved using the server on which   	the file or directory resides. </para> -		<para>ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID.  This SID again  -		can be specified in CWS-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case  -		it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory  -		resides.  The type, flags and mask values determine the type of  -		access granted to the SID. </para> - -		<para>The type can be either 0 or 1 corresponding to ALLOWED or  -		DENIED access to the SID.  The flags values are generally -		zero for file ACLs and either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs.  Some  -		common flags are: </para> - -		<itemizedlist>  -			<listitem><para>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT     	0x1</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT  	0x2</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT       0x4 -			</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY       	0x8</para> -			</listitem> +	<para>ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID.  This SID again  +	can be specified in CWS-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case  +	it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory  +	resides.  The type, flags and mask values determine the type of  +	access granted to the SID. </para> + +	<para>The type can be either 0 or 1 corresponding to ALLOWED or  +	DENIED access to the SID.  The flags values are generally +	zero for file ACLs and either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs.  Some  +	common flags are: </para> + +	<itemizedlist>  +		<listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT     	0x1</constant></para></listitem> +		<listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT  	0x2</constant></para></listitem> +		<listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT     0x4</constant></para></listitem> +		<listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY       	0x8</constant></para></listitem>   	</itemizedlist>  	<para>At present flags can only be specified as decimal or  @@ -233,8 +232,7 @@ ACL:<sid or name>:<type>/<flags>/<mask>  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -249,7 +247,8 @@ ACL:<sid or name>:<type>/<flags>/<mask>  	and Tim Potter.</para>  	<para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done +	by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbclient.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbclient.1.sgml index 43994a4529..7e908e5d70 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbclient.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbclient.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbclient"> +<refentry id="smbclient.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> @@ -44,12 +44,13 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbclient</command> is a client that can   	'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It offers an interface -	similar to that of the ftp program (see <command>ftp(1)</command>).   +	similar to that of the ftp program (see <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ftp</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>).    	Operations include things like getting files from the server   	to the local machine, putting files from the local machine to   	the server, retrieving directory information from the server  @@ -81,7 +82,9 @@  		<para>The server name is looked up according to either   		the <parameter>-R</parameter> parameter to <command>smbclient</command> or  -		using the name resolve order parameter in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file,  +		using the name resolve order parameter in  +		the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file,   		allowing an administrator to change the order and methods   		by which server names are looked up. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -113,15 +116,17 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-s smb.conf</term> -		<listitem><para>Specifies the location of the all important  -		<filename>smb.conf</filename> file. </para></listitem> +		<listitem><para>Specifies the location of the all  +		important <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-O socket options</term>  		<listitem><para>TCP socket options to set on the client  -		socket. See the socket options parameter in the <filename> -		smb.conf (5)</filename> manpage for the list of valid  +		socket. See the socket options parameter in  +		the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manual page for the list of valid   		options. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -134,44 +139,51 @@  		string of different name resolution options.</para>  		<para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They  -		cause names to be resolved as follows :</para> +		cause names to be resolved as follows:</para>  		<itemizedlist> -			<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant> : Lookup an IP  +			<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant>: Lookup an IP   			address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has  -			no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <ulink  -			url="lmhosts.5.html">lmhosts(5)</ulink> for details) then -			any name type matches for lookup.</para></listitem> - -			<listitem><para><constant>host</constant> : Do a standard host  +			no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see  +			the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle> +			<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details) then +			any name type matches for lookup.</para> +			</listitem> +			 +			<listitem><para><constant>host</constant>: Do a standard host   			name to IP address resolution, using the system <filename>/etc/hosts  			</filename>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution   			is operating system dependent, for instance on IRIX or Solaris this   			may be controlled by the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename>   			file).  Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name   			type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise  -			it is ignored.</para></listitem> - -			<listitem><para><constant>wins</constant> : Query a name with  +			it is ignored.</para> +			</listitem> +			 +			<listitem><para><constant>wins</constant>: Query a name with   			the IP address listed in the <parameter>wins server</parameter>  			parameter.  If no WINS server has -			been specified this method will be ignored.</para></listitem> - -			<listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant> : Do a broadcast on  +			been specified this method will be ignored.</para> +			</listitem> +			 +			<listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant>: Do a broadcast on   			each of the known local interfaces listed in the   			<parameter>interfaces</parameter>  			parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution   			methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally  -			connected subnet.</para></listitem> +			connected subnet.</para> +			</listitem>  		</itemizedlist>  		<para>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order  -		defined in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file parameter   +		defined in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file parameter    		(name resolve order) will be used. </para>  		<para>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without   		this parameter or any entry in the <parameter>name resolve order -		</parameter> parameter of the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file the name resolution +		</parameter> parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file the name resolution  		methods will be attempted in this order. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -202,8 +214,8 @@  		<parameter>-I</parameter> options useful, as they allow you to   		control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </para> -		<para>See the message command parameter in the <filename> -		smb.conf(5)</filename> for a description of how to handle incoming  +		<para>See the <parameter>message command</parameter> parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for a description of how to handle incoming   		WinPopup messages in Samba. </para>  		<para><emphasis>Note</emphasis>: Copy WinPopup into the startup group  @@ -379,11 +391,11 @@  		password used in the connection.  The format of the file is   		</para> -		<para><programlisting> +<para><programlisting>  username = <value>   password = <value>  domain = <value> -		</programlisting></para> +</programlisting></para>  		<para>If the domain parameter is missing the current workgroup name @@ -435,9 +447,9 @@ domain = <value>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-W WORKGROUP</term>  		<listitem><para>Override the default workgroup (domain) specified -		in the workgroup parameter of the <filename>smb.conf</filename> -		file for this connection. This may be needed to connect to some -		servers. </para></listitem> +		in the workgroup parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>	file for this connection. This may be  +		needed to connect to some servers. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -519,7 +531,7 @@ domain = <value>  		<para><emphasis>Tar Filenames</emphasis></para> -		<para>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with '\'  +		<para>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with '\\'   		as the component separator) or as UNIX path names (with '/' as   		the component separator). </para> @@ -587,7 +599,7 @@ domain = <value>  	<para><prompt>smb:\> </prompt></para> -	<para>The backslash ("\") indicates the current working directory  +	<para>The backslash ("\\") indicates the current working directory   	on the server, and will change if the current working directory   	is changed. </para> @@ -1040,8 +1052,8 @@ domain = <value>  	and writeable only by the user. </para>  	<para>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a  -	running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <command>smbd(8) -	</command> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon  +	running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon   	on a user-accessible port (typically any port number over 1024)  	would provide a suitable test server. </para>  </refsect1> @@ -1063,8 +1075,7 @@ domain = <value>  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -1078,11 +1089,11 @@ domain = <value>  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 +	was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcontrol.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcontrol.1.sgml index 166ef63e87..6632e07269 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcontrol.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbcontrol.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbcontrol"> +<refentry id="smbcontrol.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle> @@ -29,14 +29,14 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbcontrol</command> is a very small program, which  -	sends messages to an <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>,  -	an <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> -	or a <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink>  -	daemon running on the system.</para> +	sends messages to a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, or a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon running on the system.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -54,8 +54,7 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>destination</term> -		<listitem><para>One of <parameter>nmbd</parameter> -		<parameter>smbd</parameter> or a process ID.</para> +		<listitem><para>One of <parameter>nmbd</parameter>, <parameter>smbd</parameter> or a process ID.</para>  		<para>The <parameter>smbd</parameter> destination causes the   		message to "broadcast" to all smbd daemons.</para> @@ -190,9 +189,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	and <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>. -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -205,11 +204,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for +	Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbd.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbd.8.sgml index 9fb80901be..32837ba903 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbd.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbd.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbd"> +<refentry id="smbd.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> @@ -32,7 +32,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This program is part of the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbd</command> is the server daemon that   	provides filesharing and printing services to Windows clients.  @@ -46,15 +47,14 @@  	<para>An extensive description of the services that the   	server can provide is given in the man page for the   	configuration file controlling the attributes of those  -	services (see <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5) -	</filename></ulink>.  This man page will not describe the  +	services (see <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.  This man page will not describe the   	services, but will concentrate on the administrative aspects   	of running the server.</para>  	<para>Please note that there are significant security  -	implications to running this server, and the <ulink -	url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink>  -	manpage should be regarded as mandatory reading before  +	implications to running this server, and the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manual page should be regarded as mandatory reading before   	proceeding with installation.</para>  	<para>A session is created whenever a client requests one.  @@ -160,9 +160,9 @@  		data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</para>  		<para>Note that specifying this parameter here will  -		override the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel">log -		level</ulink> parameter in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"> -		<filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> file.</para> +		override the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><parameter>log +		level</parameter></ulink> parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -175,9 +175,9 @@  		messages from the running server. The log   		file generated is never removed by the server although   		its size may be controlled by the <ulink  -		url="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize">max log size</ulink> -		option in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename> -		smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> file. <emphasis>Beware:</emphasis> +		url="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize"><parameter>max log size</parameter></ulink> +		option in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file. <emphasis>Beware:</emphasis>  		If the directory specified does not exist, <command>smbd</command>  		will log to the default debug log location defined at compile time.  		</para> @@ -189,9 +189,9 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-O <socket options></term>  		<listitem><para>See the <ulink  -		url="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions">socket options</ulink>  -		parameter in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5) -		</filename></ulink> file for details.</para></listitem> +		url="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><parameter>socket options</parameter></ulink>  +		parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file for details.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> @@ -226,8 +226,8 @@  		information in this file includes server-specific  		information such as what printcap file to use, as well   		as descriptions of all the services that the server is  -		to provide. See <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename> -		smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> for more information. +		to provide. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information.  		The default configuration file name is determined at   		compile time.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -243,7 +243,7 @@  		<listitem><para>If the server is to be run by the   		<command>inetd</command> meta-daemon, this file   		must contain suitable startup information for the  -		meta-daemon. See the <ulink url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> +		meta-daemon. See the <ulink url="install.html">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</ulink>  		document for details.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -255,7 +255,7 @@  		<para>If running the server as a daemon at startup,   		this file will need to contain an appropriate startup  -		sequence for the server. See the <ulink url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> +		sequence for the server. See the <ulink url="install.html">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</ulink>  		document for details.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -265,21 +265,20 @@  		meta-daemon <command>inetd</command>, this file   		must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)   		to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).  -		See the <ulink url="UNIX_INSTALL.html">UNIX_INSTALL.html</ulink> +		See the <ulink url="install.html">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</ulink>  		document for details.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term> -		<listitem><para>This is the default location of the  -		<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf</filename></ulink> -		server configuration file. Other common places that systems  +		<listitem><para>This is the default location of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> server configuration file. Other common places that systems   		install this file are <filename>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename>  -		and <filename>/etc/smb.conf</filename>.</para> +		and <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename>.</para>  		<para>This file describes all the services the server  -		is to make available to clients. See <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"> -		<filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink>  for more information.</para> +		is to make available to clients. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist> @@ -317,9 +316,9 @@  	<para>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext   	password), for account checking (is this account disabled?) and for  	session management.  The degree too which samba supports PAM is restricted -	by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESRICTIONS">obey pam restricions</ulink> -	smb.conf paramater.  When this is set, the following restrictions apply: +	by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESRICTIONS"><parameter>obey  +	pam restricions</parameter></ulink> <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> paramater.  When this is set, the following restrictions apply:  	</para>  	<itemizedlist> @@ -379,9 +378,9 @@  	it to die on its own.</para>  	<para>The debug log level of <command>smbd</command> may be raised -	or lowered using <ulink url="smbcontrol.1.html"><command>smbcontrol(1) -	</command></ulink> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer used in -	Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,  +	or lowered using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer  +	used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,   	whilst still running at a normally low log level.</para>  	<para>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write,  @@ -394,14 +393,15 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para>hosts_access(5), <command>inetd(8)</command>,  -	<ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> -	</ulink>, <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1) -	</command></ulink>, <ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command> -	testparm(1)</command></ulink>, <ulink url="testprns.1.html"> -	<command>testprns(1)</command></ulink>, and the Internet RFC's -	<filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.  +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>hosts_access</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>inetd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and the  +	Internet RFC's	<filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.   	In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available   	as a link from the Web page <ulink url="http://samba.org/cifs/">   	http://samba.org/cifs/</ulink>.</para> @@ -417,11 +417,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for +	Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbgroupedit.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbgroupedit.8.sgml index 188218c249..6c489bb785 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbgroupedit.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbgroupedit.8.sgml @@ -1,15 +1,11 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbgroupedit"> +<refentry id="smbgroupedit.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbgroupedit</refentrytitle>  	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum>  </refmeta> - -<!-- **************************************************** -**              Name and Options                       ** -**************************************************** -->  <refnamediv>  	<refname>smbgroupedit</refname>  	<refpurpose>Query/set/change UNIX - Windows NT group mapping</refpurpose> @@ -25,17 +21,13 @@ -<!-- **************************************************** -**                     Description                     ** -**************************************************** -->  <refsect1>  <title>DESCRIPTION</title>  <para> -This program is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html">Samba</ulink> -suite. -</para> +This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  <para>  The  smbgroupedit  command  allows for mapping unix groups @@ -70,8 +62,8 @@ etc.      Privilege      :  </programlisting></para> -<para>For examples,</para> -<para><programlisting> +<para>For example: +<programlisting>  Users      SID       : S-1-5-32-545      Unix group: -1 @@ -91,9 +83,8 @@ Users  NTGroupName(SID) -> UnixGroupName  </programlisting></para> -<para>For example,</para> - -<para><programlisting> +<para>For example: +<programlisting>  Users (S-1-5-32-545) -> -1  </programlisting></para> @@ -109,8 +100,6 @@ Users (S-1-5-32-545) -> -1 -<!-- **************************************************** -**************************************************** -->  <refsect1>  <title>FILES</title> @@ -120,8 +109,6 @@ Users (S-1-5-32-545) -> -1 -<!-- **************************************************** -**************************************************** -->  <refsect1>  <title>EXIT STATUS</title> @@ -163,65 +150,45 @@ the 'Domain Admins'  Global group:  	<para>domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary</para>  	</listitem> -	<listitem><para>map this domadm group to the 'domain admins' group: -	</para> +	<listitem><para>map this domadm group to the 'domain admins' group:</para>  	<orderedlist> -		<listitem><para>Get the SID for the Windows NT "Domain Admins" -		group:</para> - +		<listitem><para>Get the SID for the Windows NT "Domain Admins" group:</para>  <para><programlisting>  <prompt>root# </prompt><command>smbgroupedit -vs | grep "Domain Admins"</command>  Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-1108995562-3116817432-1375597819-512) -> -1 -</programlisting></para> -</listitem> +</programlisting></para></listitem>  		<listitem><para>map the unix domadm group to the Windows NT  		"Domain Admins" group, by running the command: -		</para> - -<para><programlisting> +<programlisting>  <prompt>root# </prompt><command>smbgroupedit \  -c S-1-5-21-1108995562-3116817432-1375597819-512 \  -u domadm -td</command>  </programlisting></para> -		<para> -		<emphasis>warning:</emphasis> don't copy and paste this sample, the +		<para><emphasis>warning:</emphasis> don't copy and paste this sample, the  		Domain Admins SID (the S-1-5-21-...-512) is different for every PDC. -		</para> -		</listitem> +		</para>	</listitem>  	</orderedlist>  	</listitem>  </orderedlist>  <para>  To verify that your mapping has taken effect: -</para> - -<para><programlisting> +<programlisting>  <prompt>root# </prompt><command>smbgroupedit -vs|grep "Domain Admins"</command>  Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-1108995562-3116817432-1375597819-512) -> domadm  </programlisting></para> -<para> -To give access to a certain directory on a domain member machine (an +<para>To give access to a certain directory on a domain member machine (an  NT/W2K or a samba server running winbind) to some users who are member  of a group on your samba PDC, flag that group as a domain group: -</para> - -<para><programlisting> +<programlisting>  <prompt>root# </prompt><command>smbgroupedit -a unixgroup -td</command>  </programlisting></para> - -  </refsect1> - - - -<!-- **************************************************** -**************************************************** -->  <refsect1>  <title>VERSION</title> @@ -232,22 +199,16 @@ the Samba suite.  </para>  </refsect1> -<!-- **************************************************** -**************************************************** --> -  <refsect1>  <title>SEE ALSO</title>  <para> -<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> -</para> +<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1> -<!-- **************************************************** -**************************************************** --> -  <refsect1>  <title>AUTHOR</title> @@ -261,7 +222,8 @@ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.  <para>  <command>smbgroupedit</command> was written by Jean Francois Micouleau.  The current set of manpages and documentation is maintained -by the Samba Team in the same fashion as the Samba source code.</para> +by the Samba Team in the same fashion as the Samba source code. The conversion +to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmnt.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmnt.8.sgml index 55b66d5d25..6d48b12b9b 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmnt.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmnt.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbmnt"> +<refentry id="smbmnt.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbmnt</refentrytitle> @@ -38,8 +38,8 @@  	by the user, and that the user has write permission on.</para>  	<para>The <command>smbmnt</command> program is normally invoked  -	by <ulink url="smbmount.8.html"><command>smbmount(8)</command> -	</ulink>. It should not be invoked directly by users. </para> +	by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbmount</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>. It should not be invoked directly by users. </para>  	<para>smbmount searches the normal PATH for smbmnt. You must ensure  	that the smbmnt version in your path matches the smbmount used.</para> @@ -107,7 +107,8 @@  	</para>  	<para>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 +	was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmount.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmount.8.sgml index c4b91a5572..d17e4e6bcf 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmount.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbmount.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbmount"> +<refentry id="smbmount.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbmount</refentrytitle> @@ -26,7 +26,8 @@  	<para><command>smbmount</command> mounts a Linux SMB filesystem. It   	is usually invoked as <command>mount.smbfs</command> by -	the <command>mount(8)</command> command when using the  +	the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>mount</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> command when using the   	"-t smbfs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must  	support the smbfs filesystem. </para> @@ -39,11 +40,12 @@  	<para><command>smbmount</command> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until  	the mounted smbfs is umounted. It will log things that happen  	when in daemon mode using the "machine name" smbmount, so -	typically this output will end up in <filename>log.smbmount</filename>. The -	<command>smbmount</command> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</para> +	typically this output will end up in <filename>log.smbmount</filename>. The <command> +	smbmount</command> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</para>  	<para><emphasis>NOTE:</emphasis> <command>smbmount</command>  -	calls <command>smbmnt(8)</command> to do the actual mount. You  +	calls <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbmnt</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to do the actual mount. You   	must make sure that <command>smbmnt</command> is in the path so   	that it can be found. </para> @@ -84,15 +86,12 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>credentials=<filename></term> -		<listitem><para>specifies a file that contains a username -		and/or password. The format of the file is:</para> - -		<para> -		<programlisting> -		username = <value> -		password = <value> -		</programlisting> -		</para> +		<listitem><para>specifies a file that contains a username and/or password.  +The format of the file is: +<programlisting> +username = <value> +password = <value> +</programlisting></para>  		<para>This is preferred over having passwords in plaintext in a  		shared file, such as <filename>/etc/fstab</filename>. Be sure to protect any @@ -174,8 +173,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>sockopt=<arg></term>  		<listitem><para>sets the TCP socket options. See the <ulink -		url="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS"><filename>smb.conf -		</filename></ulink> <parameter>socket options</parameter> option. +		url="smb.conf.5.html#SOCKETOPTIONS"><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></ulink> <parameter>socket options</parameter> option.  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -298,10 +297,9 @@  	<para>FreeBSD also has a smbfs, but it is not related to smbmount</para> -	<para>For Solaris, HP-UX and others you may want to look at -	<ulink url="smbsh.1.html"><command>smbsh(1)</command></ulink> or at other -	solutions, such as sharity or perhaps replacing the SMB server with -	a NFS server.</para> +	<para>For Solaris, HP-UX and others you may want to look at <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbsh</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> or at other solutions, such as  +	Sharity or perhaps replacing the SMB server with a NFS server.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -321,7 +319,8 @@  	</para>  	<para>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 +	was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.5.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.5.sgml index 5c80ac4c06..f78e986bef 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.5.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.5.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbpasswd"> +<refentry id="smbpasswd.5">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> @@ -19,8 +19,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains   	the username, Unix user id and the SMB hashed passwords of the  @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@  		the attributes of the users account. In the Samba 2.2 release   		this field is bracketed by '[' and ']' characters and is always   		13 characters in length (including the '[' and ']' characters). -		The contents of this field may be any of the characters. +		The contents of this field may be any of the following characters:  		</para>  		<itemizedlist> @@ -136,12 +136,11 @@  			Password Hash and NT Password Hash are ignored). Note that this   			will only allow users to log on with no password if the <parameter>  			null passwords</parameter> parameter is set in the <ulink -			url="smb.conf.5.html#NULLPASSWORDS"><filename>smb.conf(5) -			</filename></ulink> config file. </para></listitem> +			url="smb.conf.5.html#NULLPASSWORDS"><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +			<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></ulink> config file. </para></listitem>  			<listitem><para><emphasis>D</emphasis> - This means the account  -			is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins  will be	allowed for  -			this user. </para></listitem> +			is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins  will be allowed for this user. </para></listitem>  			<listitem><para><emphasis>W</emphasis> - This means this account   			is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used  @@ -178,8 +177,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>, and +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and  	the Internet RFC1321 for details on the MD4 algorithm.  	</para>  </refsect1> @@ -194,11 +194,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.8.sgml index 8e6d925ae0..5d475cf08c 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbpasswd.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbpasswd"> +<refentry id="smbpasswd.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> @@ -37,25 +37,27 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>The smbpasswd program has several different  -	functions, depending on whether it is run by the <emphasis>root</emphasis>  -	user or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change  +	functions, depending on whether it is run by the <emphasis>root</emphasis> user  +	or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change   	the password used for their SMB sessions on any machines that store   	SMB passwords. </para>  	<para>By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to   	change the current user's SMB password on the local machine. This is  -	similar to the way the <command>passwd(1)</command> program works.  -	<command>smbpasswd</command> differs from how the passwd program works  +	similar to the way the <command>passwd(1)</command> program works. <command> +	smbpasswd</command> differs from how the passwd program works   	however in that it is not <emphasis>setuid root</emphasis> but works in  -	a client-server mode and communicates with a locally running -	<command>smbd(8)</command>. As a consequence in order for this to  +	a client-server mode and communicates with a  +	locally running <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>. As a consequence in order for this to   	succeed the smbd daemon must be running on the local machine. On a   	UNIX machine the encrypted SMB passwords are usually stored in  -	the <filename>smbpasswd(5)</filename> file. </para> +	the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file. </para>  	<para>When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd   	will prompt them for their old SMB password and then ask them  @@ -67,12 +69,13 @@  	<para>smbpasswd can also be used by a normal user to change their  	SMB password on remote machines, such as Windows NT Primary Domain  -	Controllers.   See the (-r) and -U options below. </para> +	Controllers.   See the (<parameter>-r</parameter>) and <parameter>-U</parameter> options  +	below. </para>  	<para>When run by root, smbpasswd allows new users to be added   	and deleted in the smbpasswd file, as well as allows changes to  -	the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root,  -	<command>smbpasswd</command> accesses the local smbpasswd file  +	the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root, <command> +	smbpasswd</command> accesses the local smbpasswd file   	directly, thus enabling changes to be made even if smbd is not   	running. </para>  </refsect1> @@ -121,8 +124,8 @@  		<para>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format (pre-Samba 2.0   		format) there is no space in the user's password entry to write -		this information and the command will FAIL. See <command>smbpasswd(5) -		</command> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats. +		this information and the command will FAIL. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.  		</para>  		<para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as  @@ -140,7 +143,8 @@  		<para>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format, then <command>  		smbpasswd</command> will FAIL to enable the account.   -                See <command>smbpasswd (5)</command> for  +                See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for   		details on the 'old' and new password file formats. </para>  		<para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.  @@ -226,15 +230,15 @@  		name of the host being connected to. </para>  		<para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They -		 cause names to be resolved as follows : </para> +		 cause names to be resolved as follows: </para>  			<itemizedlist> -				<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant> : Lookup an IP  +				<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant>: Lookup an IP               address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has  -            no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <ulink  -            url="lmhosts.5.html">lmhosts(5)</ulink> for details) then +            no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle> +	    <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details) then              any name type matches for lookup.</para></listitem> -            <listitem><para><constant>host</constant> : Do a standard host  +            <listitem><para><constant>host</constant>: Do a standard host               name to IP address resolution, using the system <filename>/etc/hosts              </filename>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution               is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this  @@ -243,12 +247,12 @@              type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise               it is ignored.</para></listitem> -            <listitem><para><constant>wins</constant> : Query a name with  +            <listitem><para><constant>wins</constant>: Query a name with               the IP address listed in the <parameter>wins server</parameter>   	    parameter.  If no WINS server has been specified this method   	    will be ignored.</para></listitem> -            <listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant> : Do a broadcast on  +            <listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant>: Do a broadcast on               each of the known local interfaces listed in the              <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter. This is the least   	    reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the  @@ -256,8 +260,8 @@  		</itemizedlist>  		<para>The default order is <command>lmhosts, host, wins, bcast</command>  -		and without this parameter or any entry in the  -		<filename>smb.conf</filename> file the name resolution methods will  +		and without this parameter or any entry in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file the name resolution methods will   		be attempted in this order. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -292,7 +296,6 @@  		</varlistentry> -		  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-s</term>  		<listitem><para>This option causes smbpasswd to be silent (i.e.  @@ -312,7 +315,7 @@  		switch is used to specify the password to be used with the   		<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN"><parameter>ldap admin   		dn</parameter></ulink>.  Note that the password is stored in -		the <filename>private/secrets.tdb</filename> and is keyed off  +		the <filename>secrets.tdb</filename> and is keyed off   		of the admin's DN.  This means that if the value of <parameter>ldap  		admin dn</parameter> ever changes, the password will need to be   		manually updated as well. @@ -355,14 +358,15 @@  	mode communicating  with a local smbd for a non-root user then   	the smbd daemon must be running for this to work. A common problem   	is to add a restriction to the hosts that may access the <command> -	smbd</command> running on the local machine by specifying a  -	<parameter>allow hosts</parameter> or <parameter>deny hosts</parameter>  -	entry in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file and neglecting to  +	smbd</command> running on the local machine by specifying either <parameter>allow +	hosts</parameter> or <parameter>deny hosts</parameter> entry in  +	the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file and neglecting to   	allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </para>  	<para>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba -	has been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the file  -	<filename>ENCRYPTION.txt</filename> in the docs directory for details  +	has been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the document <ulink url="pwencrypt.html"> +	"LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba"</ulink> in the docs directory for details   	on how to do this. </para>  </refsect1> @@ -370,15 +374,14 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html"><filename>smbpasswd(5)</filename></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink> -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -391,11 +394,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbsh.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbsh.1.sgml index c40609be4f..af080c298c 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbsh.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbsh.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbsh"> +<refentry id="smbsh.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbsh</refentrytitle> @@ -29,8 +29,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbsh</command> allows you to access an NT filesystem   	using UNIX commands such as <command>ls</command>, <command> @@ -46,7 +46,8 @@  	    <varlistentry>  		<term>-W WORKGROUP</term>  		<listitem><para>Override the default workgroup specified in the  -		workgroup parameter of the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file  +		workgroup parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file   		for this session. This may be needed to connect to some   		servers. </para></listitem>  	    </varlistentry> @@ -61,7 +62,8 @@  	    </varlistentry>  	    <varlistentry> -		<term>-P prefix</term><listitem><para>This option allows +		<term>-P prefix</term> +		<listitem><para>This option allows  		the user to set the directory prefix for SMB access. The   		default value if this option is not specified is   		<emphasis>smb</emphasis>. @@ -75,19 +77,20 @@  		host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated   		string of different name resolution options.</para> -		<para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast".  +		<para>The options are: "lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast".   		They cause names to be resolved as follows :</para>  		<itemizedlist> -			<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant> :  +			<listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant>:   			Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the   			line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the   			NetBIOS name  -			(see the <ulink url="lmhosts.5.html">lmhosts(5)</ulink> -			for details) then any name type matches for lookup. +			(see the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle> +			<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>	for details)  +			then any name type matches for lookup.  			</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para><constant>host</constant> :  +			<listitem><para><constant>host</constant>:   			Do a standard host name to IP address resolution, using  			the system <filename>/etc/hosts</filename>, NIS, or DNS  			lookups. This method of name resolution is operating  @@ -98,14 +101,14 @@  			(server) name type, otherwise it is ignored.  			</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para><constant>wins</constant> :  +			<listitem><para><constant>wins</constant>:   			Query a name with the IP address listed in the   			<parameter>wins server</parameter> parameter.  If no   			WINS server has been specified this method will be   			ignored.  			</para></listitem> -			<listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant> :  +			<listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant>:   			Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces   			listed in the <parameter>interfaces</parameter>  			parameter. This is the least reliable of the name  @@ -115,14 +118,15 @@  		</itemizedlist>  		<para>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order  -		defined in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file parameter   -		(name resolve order) will be used. </para> +		defined in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file parameter   +		(<parameter>name resolve order</parameter>) will be used. </para>  		<para>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without   		this parameter or any entry in the <parameter>name resolve order -		</parameter> parameter of the <filename>smb.conf</filename>  -		file, the name resolution methods will be attempted in this  -		order. </para></listitem> +		</parameter> parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file, the name resolution methods  +		will be attempted in this order. </para></listitem>  	    </varlistentry>  	    <varlistentry> @@ -133,7 +137,8 @@  		is zero.</para>  		<para>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged -		about the activities of <command>nmblookup</command>. At level +		about the activities of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>. At level  		0, only critical errors and serious warnings will be logged.  		</para></listitem>  	    </varlistentry> @@ -164,13 +169,12 @@  	<para>To use the <command>smbsh</command> command, execute <command>  	smbsh</command> from the prompt and enter the username and password   	that authenticates you to the machine running the Windows NT  -	operating system.</para> - -	<para><programlisting> -	<prompt>system% </prompt><userinput>smbsh</userinput> -	<prompt>Username: </prompt><userinput>user</userinput> -	<prompt>Password: </prompt><userinput>XXXXXXX</userinput> -	</programlisting></para> +	operating system. +<programlisting> +<prompt>system% </prompt><userinput>smbsh</userinput> +<prompt>Username: </prompt><userinput>user</userinput> +<prompt>Password: </prompt><userinput>XXXXXXX</userinput> +</programlisting></para>  	<para>Any dynamically linked command you execute from  @@ -188,8 +192,7 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -210,9 +213,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -225,11 +228,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbspool.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbspool.8.sgml index d164cb0864..f30539601e 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbspool.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbspool.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbspool"> +<refentry id="smbspool.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbspool</refentrytitle> @@ -27,8 +27,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>smbspool is a very small print spooling program that   	sends a print file to an SMB printer. The command-line arguments  @@ -45,10 +45,8 @@  	<itemizedlist>  		<listitem><para>smb://server/printer</para></listitem>  		<listitem><para>smb://workgroup/server/printer</para></listitem> -		<listitem><para>smb://username:password@server/printer</para> -		</listitem> -		<listitem><para>smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printer -		</para></listitem> +		<listitem><para>smb://username:password@server/printer</para></listitem> +		<listitem><para>smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printer</para></listitem>  	</itemizedlist>  	<para>smbspool tries to get the URI from argv[0]. If argv[0]  @@ -97,15 +95,14 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	and <ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>. -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -121,11 +118,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbstatus.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbstatus.1.sgml index 99963a4bec..67d39f2586 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbstatus.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbstatus.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbstatus"> +<refentry id="smbstatus.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbstatus</refentrytitle> @@ -31,8 +31,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbstatus</command> is a very simple program to   	list the current Samba connections.</para> @@ -84,8 +84,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-p|--processes</term> -		<listitem><para>print a list of <ulink url="smbd.8.html"> -		<command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> processes and exit.  +		<listitem><para>print a list of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> processes and exit.   		Useful for scripting.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -102,9 +102,9 @@  		<term>-s|--conf=<configuration file></term>  		<listitem><para>The default configuration file name is  		determined at compile time. The file specified contains the -		configuration details required by the server. See <ulink  -		url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> -		</ulink> for more information.</para> +		configuration details required by the server. See <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> for more information.</para>  		</listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -128,8 +128,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> and -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink>.</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -142,11 +143,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbtar.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbtar.1.sgml index bd70493b6b..ffb5087347 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbtar.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbtar.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbtar"> +<refentry id="smbtar.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbtar</refentrytitle> @@ -37,12 +37,12 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>smbtar</command> is a very small shell script on top  -	of <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink>  -	which dumps SMB shares directly to tape. </para> +	of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -144,8 +144,9 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-l log level</term>  		<listitem><para>Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the  -		<parameter>-d</parameter> flag of <command>smbclient(1) -		</command>. </para></listitem> +		<parameter>-d</parameter> flag of <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry>.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist>  </refsect1> @@ -181,9 +182,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DIAGNOSTICS</title> -	<para>See the <emphasis>DIAGNOSTICS</emphasis> section for the  -	<ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command>  -	</ulink> command.</para> +	<para>See the <emphasis>DIAGNOSTICS</emphasis> section for the <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry> command.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -196,10 +197,11 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink>, -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -216,11 +218,11 @@  	url="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de">Martin Kraemer</ulink>. Many   	thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug   	fixes, etc. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter.</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for +	Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbumount.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbumount.8.sgml index d6a1b65b57..089ede79ea 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/smbumount.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/smbumount.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="smbumount"> +<refentry id="smbumount.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>smbumount</refentrytitle> @@ -47,8 +47,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smbmount.8.html"><command>smbmount(8)</command> -	</ulink></para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbmount</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1> @@ -67,7 +67,8 @@  	</para>  	<para>The conversion of this manpage for Samba 2.2 was performed  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 +	was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/swat.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/swat.8.sgml index c0052f3d53..9c4daad6d0 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/swat.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/swat.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="swat"> +<refentry id="swat.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle> @@ -23,13 +23,13 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>swat</command> allows a Samba administrator to  -	configure the complex <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename> -	smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink> file via a Web browser. In addition,  +	configure the complex <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file via a Web browser. In addition,   	a <command>swat</command> configuration page has help links   	to all the configurable options in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file allowing an   	administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </para> @@ -46,8 +46,9 @@  		<term>-s smb configuration file</term>  		<listitem><para>The default configuration file path is   		determined at compile time.  The file specified contains  -		the configuration details required by the <command>smbd -		</command> server. This is the file that <command>swat</command> will modify.  +		the configuration details required by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> server. This is the file  +		that <command>swat</command> will modify.   		The information in this file includes server-specific   		information such as what printcap file to use, as well as   		descriptions of all the services that the server is to provide. @@ -152,8 +153,9 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term> -		<listitem><para>This is the default location of the <filename>smb.conf(5) -		</filename> server configuration file that swat edits. Other  +		<listitem><para>This is the default location of the <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> server configuration file that swat edits. Other   		common places that systems install this file are <filename>  		/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename> and <filename>/etc/smb.conf  		</filename>.  This file describes all the services the server  @@ -166,8 +168,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>WARNINGS</title> -	<para><command>swat</command> will rewrite your <filename>smb.conf -	</filename> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all  +	<para><command>swat</command> will rewrite your <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all   	comments, <parameter>include=</parameter> and <parameter>copy=  	</parameter> options. If you have a carefully crafted <filename>  	smb.conf</filename> then back it up or don't use swat! </para> @@ -177,16 +180,15 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>VERSION</title> -	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of  -	the Samba suite.</para> +	<para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of the Samba suite.</para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><command>inetd(5)</command>, -	<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> -	</para> +	<para><command>inetd(5)</command>, <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -199,11 +201,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for +	Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/testparm.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/testparm.1.sgml index f34528a43d..ec8092a926 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/testparm.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/testparm.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="testparm"> +<refentry id="testparm.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle> @@ -29,11 +29,12 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>testparm</command> is a very simple test program  -	to check an <command>smbd</command> configuration file for  +	to check an <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file for   	internal correctness. If this program reports no problems, you   	can use the configuration file with confidence that <command>smbd  	</command> will successfully load the configuration file.</para> @@ -82,9 +83,9 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-v</term>  		<listitem><para>If this option is specified, testparm  -		will also output all options that were not used in  -		<filename>smb.conf</filename> and are thus set to -		their defaults.</para></listitem> +		will also output all options that were not used in <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> and are thus set to their defaults.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry> @@ -98,7 +99,8 @@  		<term>configfilename</term>  		<listitem><para>This is the name of the configuration file   		to check. If this parameter is not present then the  -		default <filename>smb.conf</filename> file will be checked. 	 +		default <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> file will be checked. 	  		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -108,7 +110,9 @@  		<listitem><para>If this parameter and the following are   		specified, then <command>testparm</command> will examine the <parameter>hosts  		allow</parameter> and <parameter>hosts deny</parameter>  -		parameters in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file to  +		parameters in the <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> file to   		determine if the hostname with this IP address would be  		allowed access to the <command>smbd</command> server.  If   		this parameter is supplied, the hostIP parameter must also @@ -130,9 +134,11 @@  	<variablelist>  		<varlistentry> -		<term><filename>smb.conf</filename></term> +		<term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry></term>  		<listitem><para>This is usually the name of the configuration  -		file used by <command>smbd</command>.  +		file used by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry>.   		</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist> @@ -158,9 +164,11 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html"><filename>smb.conf(5)</filename></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> -	</para> +	<para><citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry>, <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -173,11 +181,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/testprns.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/testprns.1.sgml index cd99494a9a..85cc860c4a 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/testprns.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/testprns.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="testprns"> +<refentry id="testprns.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle> @@ -23,13 +23,13 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>testprns</command> is a very simple test program   	to determine whether a given printer name is valid for use in  -	a service to be provided by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command> -	smbd(8)</command></ulink>. </para> +	a service to be provided by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>  	<para>"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the   	printcap specified". This program is very stupid - so stupid in  @@ -54,8 +54,9 @@  		done beyond that required to extract the printer name. It may  		be that the print spooling system is more forgiving or less   		forgiving than <command>testprns</command>. However, if  -		<command>testprns</command> finds the printer then  -		<command>smbd</command> should do so as well. </para></listitem> +		<command>testprns</command> finds the printer then <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> should do so as well. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>	 @@ -117,9 +118,9 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title>  	<para><filename>printcap(5)</filename>,  -	<ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,  -	<ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink> -	</para> +	<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -132,11 +133,11 @@  	<para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.   	The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another  -	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at -	<ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"> +	excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">  	ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0   	release by Jeremy Allison.  The conversion to DocBook for  -	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para> +	Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 +	for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/vfstest.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/vfstest.1.sgml index d6c7e5f142..c89035d814 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/vfstest.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/vfstest.1.sgml @@ -1,8 +1,7 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN" [  <!ENTITY % globalentities SYSTEM '../global.ent'> %globalentities;  ]> - -<refentry id="vfstest"> +<refentry id="vfstest.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>vfstest</refentrytitle> @@ -28,8 +27,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>vfstest</command> is a small command line  	utility that has the ability to test dso samba VFS modules. It gives the diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/wbinfo.1.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/wbinfo.1.sgml index a6ca244243..5003c847a4 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/wbinfo.1.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/wbinfo.1.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="wbinfo"> +<refentry id="wbinfo.1">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle> @@ -37,14 +37,15 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This tool is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para>The <command>wbinfo</command> program queries and returns information  -	created and used by the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html"><command> -	winbindd(8)</command></ulink> daemon. </para> +	created and used by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon. </para> -	<para>The <command>winbindd(8)</command> daemon must be configured  +	<para>The <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon must be configured   	and running for the <command>wbinfo</command> program to be able   	to return information.</para>  </refsect1> @@ -56,27 +57,30 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-u</term>  		<listitem><para>This option will list all users available  -		in the Windows NT domain for which the <command>winbindd(8) -		</command> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains  +		in the Windows NT domain for which the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains   		will also be listed.  Note that this operation does not assign  -		user ids to any users that have not already been seen by  -		<command>winbindd(8)</command>.</para></listitem> +		user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> +		.</para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-g</term>  		<listitem><para>This option will list all groups available  -		in the Windows NT domain for which the <command>winbindd(8) -		</command> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains +		in the Windows NT domain for which the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains  		will also be listed.  Note that this operation does not assign  -		group ids to any groups that have not already been seen by -		<command>winbindd(8)</command>. </para></listitem> +		group ids to any groups that have not already been  +		seen by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-N name</term>  		<listitem><para>The <parameter>-N</parameter> option  -		queries <command>winbindd(8)</command> to query the WINS +		queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to query the WINS  		server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name  		specified by the <parameter>name</parameter> parameter.  		</para></listitem> @@ -86,7 +90,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-I ip</term>  		<listitem><para>The <parameter>-I</parameter> option  -		queries <command>winbindd(8)</command> to send a node status +		queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to send a node status  		request to get the NetBIOS name associated with the IP address  		specified by the <parameter>ip</parameter> parameter.  		</para></listitem> @@ -96,13 +101,15 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-n name</term>  		<listitem><para>The <parameter>-n</parameter> option  -		queries <command>winbindd(8)</command> for the SID 		 +		queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> for the SID 		  		associated with the name specified. Domain names can be specified   		before the user name by using the winbind separator character.    		For example CWDOM1/Administrator refers to the Administrator  		user in the domain CWDOM1.  If no domain is specified then the  -		domain used is the one specified in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> -		<parameter>workgroup</parameter> parameter. </para></listitem> +		domain used is the one specified in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>	<parameter>workgroup +		</parameter> parameter. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -135,16 +142,18 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-S sid</term>  		<listitem><para>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id.  If the SID  -		does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <command> -		winbindd(8)</command> then the operation will fail. </para></listitem> +		does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +		</citerefentry> then the operation will fail. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-Y sid</term>  		<listitem><para>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id.  If the SID  -		does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <command> -		winbindd(8)</command> then the operation will fail. </para></listitem> +		does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <citerefentry> +		<refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> then  +		the operation will fail. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry> @@ -160,7 +169,8 @@  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-m</term>  		<listitem><para>Produce a list of domains trusted by the  -		Windows NT server <command>winbindd(8)</command> contacts  +		Windows NT server <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> contacts   		when resolving names.  This list does not include the Windows   		NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for.  		</para></listitem> @@ -201,8 +211,9 @@  	<title>EXIT STATUS</title>  	<para>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation  -	succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed.  If the <command>winbindd(8) -	</command> daemon is not working <command>wbinfo</command> will always return  +	succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed.  If the <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry> daemon is not working <command>wbinfo</command> will always return   	failure. </para>  </refsect1> @@ -216,8 +227,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><ulink url="winbindd.8.html"><command>winbindd(8)</command> -	</ulink></para> +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -232,7 +243,8 @@  	were written by Tim Potter.</para>  	<para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba +	3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> diff --git a/docs/docbook/manpages/winbindd.8.sgml b/docs/docbook/manpages/winbindd.8.sgml index ccef2fa623..68f41afead 100644 --- a/docs/docbook/manpages/winbindd.8.sgml +++ b/docs/docbook/manpages/winbindd.8.sgml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@  <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN"> -<refentry id="winbindd"> +<refentry id="winbindd.8">  <refmeta>  	<refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> @@ -29,8 +29,8 @@  <refsect1>  	<title>DESCRIPTION</title> -	<para>This program is part of the <ulink url="samba.7.html"> -	Samba</ulink> suite.</para> +	<para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>  	<para><command>winbindd</command> is a daemon that provides   	a service for the Name Service Switch capability that is present  @@ -88,12 +88,11 @@  	<filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file can be used to initially   	resolve user and group information from <filename>/etc/passwd  	</filename> and <filename>/etc/group</filename> and then from the  -	Windows NT server. </para> - -	<para><programlisting> +	Windows NT server. +<programlisting>  passwd:         files winbind  group:          files winbind -	</programlisting></para>   +</programlisting></para>    	<para>The following simple configuration in the  	<filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file can be used to initially @@ -172,7 +171,8 @@ group:          files winbind  		<varlistentry>  		<term>-s|--conf=smb.conf</term>  		<listitem><para>Specifies the location of the all-important -		<filename>smb.conf</filename> file. </para></listitem> +		<citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file. </para></listitem>  		</varlistentry>  	</variablelist>  </refsect1> @@ -208,8 +208,9 @@ group:          files winbind  	<title>CONFIGURATION</title>  	<para>Configuration of the <command>winbindd</command> daemon  -	is done through configuration parameters in the <filename>smb.conf(5) -	</filename> file.  All parameters should be specified in the  +	is done through configuration parameters in the <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum> +	</citerefentry> file.  All parameters should be specified in the   	[global] section of smb.conf. </para>  	<itemizedlist> @@ -243,27 +244,24 @@ group:          files winbind  	following setup. This was tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box. </para>  	<para>In <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> put the  -	following:</para> - -	<para><programlisting> +	following: +<programlisting>  passwd:     files winbind  group:      files winbind -	</programlisting></para>   - -	<para>In <filename>/etc/pam.d/*</filename> replace the  -	<parameter>auth</parameter> lines with something like this: </para> +</programlisting></para>   -  -	<para><programlisting> +	<para>In <filename>/etc/pam.d/*</filename> replace the <parameter> +	auth</parameter> lines with something like this: +<programlisting>  auth       required	/lib/security/pam_securetty.so  auth       required	/lib/security/pam_nologin.so  auth       sufficient	/lib/security/pam_winbind.so  auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok -	</programlisting></para> +</programlisting></para> -	<para>Note in particular the use of the <parameter>sufficient</parameter>  -	keyword and the <parameter>use_first_pass</parameter> keyword. </para> +	<para>Note in particular the use of the <parameter>sufficient +	</parameter> keyword and the <parameter>use_first_pass</parameter> keyword. </para>  	<para>Now replace the account lines with this: </para>  @@ -282,17 +280,17 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok  	for "PDC".</para>  	<para>Next copy <filename>libnss_winbind.so</filename> to  -	<filename>/lib</filename> and <filename>pam_winbind.so</filename> -	to <filename>/lib/security</filename>.  A symbolic link needs to be +	<filename>/lib</filename> and <filename>pam_winbind.so +	</filename> to <filename>/lib/security</filename>.  A symbolic link needs to be  	made from <filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so</filename> to  	<filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</filename>.  If you are using an  	older version of glibc then the target of the link should be  	<filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</filename>.</para> -	<para>Finally, setup a <filename>smb.conf</filename> containing directives like the  -	following:  </para>  - -	<para><programlisting> +	<para>Finally, setup a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> containing directives like the  +	following: +<programlisting>  [global]  	winbind separator = +          winbind cache time = 10 @@ -303,7 +301,7 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok          workgroup = DOMAIN          security = domain          password server = * -	</programlisting></para> +</programlisting></para>  	<para>Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and  @@ -321,9 +319,10 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok  	<para>The following notes are useful when configuring and   	running <command>winbindd</command>: </para> -	<para><command>nmbd</command> must be running on the local machine  -	for <command>winbindd</command> to work. <command>winbindd</command> -	queries the list of trusted domains for the Windows NT server +	<para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> must be running on the local machine  +	for <command>winbindd</command> to work. <command>winbindd</command> queries +	the list of trusted domains for the Windows NT server  	on startup and when a SIGHUP is received.  Thus, for a running <command>  	winbindd</command> to become aware of new trust relationships between   	servers, it must be sent a SIGHUP signal. </para> @@ -357,8 +356,9 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok  	<variablelist>  		<varlistentry>  		<term>SIGHUP</term> -		<listitem><para>Reload the <filename>smb.conf(5)</filename> -		file and apply any parameter changes to the running  +		<listitem><para>Reload the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +		<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file and  +		apply any parameter changes to the running   		version of winbindd.  This signal also clears any cached   		user and group information.  The list of other domains trusted   		by winbindd is also reloaded.  </para></listitem> @@ -431,10 +431,13 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok  <refsect1>  	<title>SEE ALSO</title> -	<para><filename>nsswitch.conf(5)</filename>, -	<ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>, -	<ulink url="wbinfo.1.html">wbinfo(1)</ulink>, -	<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink></para> +	<para><filename>nsswitch.conf(5)</filename>, <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry> +	<refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> +	<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>  </refsect1>  <refsect1> @@ -445,11 +448,12 @@ auth       required     /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok  	by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar   	to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para> -	<para><command>wbinfo</command> and <command>winbindd</command> -	were written by Tim Potter.</para> +	<para><command>wbinfo</command> and <command>winbindd</command> were  +	written by Tim Potter.</para>  	<para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done  -	by Gerald Carter</para> +	by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for +	Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>  </refsect1>  </refentry> | 
